form10k.htm


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
__________________
FORM 10-K

T            ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2011

OR

o            TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from _______ to _______

Commission file number 0-22140.

META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
(Name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware
 
42-1406262
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
     
121 East Fifth Street, Storm Lake, Iowa
 
50588
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip Code)

Registrant’s telephone number: (712) 732-4117

Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of Class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
 
NASDAQ Global Market

Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. YES o NO T

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to be file reports pursuant Section 13 and Section 15(d) of the Act. YES o NO T

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. YES T NO o

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit and post such files). YES T NO o.

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer o Accelerated filer o Non-accelerated filer o Smaller Reporting Company T

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). o YES T NO

As of March 31, 2011, the aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant, computed by reference to the average of the closing bid and asked prices of such stock on the NASDAQ Global Market as of such date, was $39.2 million.

As of December 16, 2011, there were outstanding 3,190,765 shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

PART III of Form 10-K -- Portions of the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held January 30, 2012.
 


 
 

 

META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
FORM 10-K

Table of Contents

   
Page No.
     
Part I.
     
Item 1.
2
Item 1A.
46
Item 1B.
62
Item 2.
62
Item 3.
62
Item 4.
64
     
Part II.
     
Item 5.
65
Item 6.
66
Item 7.
67
Item 7A.
84
Item 8.
86
Item 9.
132
Item 9A.
132
Item 9B.
134
     
Part III.
     
Item 10.
134
Item 11.
134
Item 12.
134
Item 13.
135
Item 14.
135
     
Part IV.
     
Item 15.
136
     
 
137

 
i


Forward-Looking Statements

Meta Financial Group, Inc.®, (“Meta Financial” or “the Company”) and its wholly-owned subsidiary, MetaBank (the “Bank” or “MetaBank”), may from time to time make written or oral “forward-looking statements,” including statements contained in its filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), in its reports to stockholders, and in other communications by the Company, which are made in good faith by the Company pursuant to the “safe harbor” provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.

These forward-looking statements include statements with respect to the Company’s beliefs, expectations, estimates, and intentions that are subject to significant risks and uncertainties, and are subject to change based on various factors, some of which are beyond the Company’s control. Such statements address, among others, the following subjects: future operating results; customer retention; loan and other product demand; important components of the Company’s balance sheet and income statements; growth and expansion; new products and services, such as those offered by the Bank or Meta Payment Systems® (“MPS”), a division of the Bank; credit quality and adequacy of reserves; technology; and our employees. The following factors, among others, could cause the Company’s financial performance to differ materially from the expectations, estimates, and intentions expressed in such forward-looking statements: the strength of the United States economy in general and the strength of the local economies in which the Company conducts operations; the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary, and fiscal policies and laws, including interest rate policies of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”, the “FRB” or the “Board”), as well as efforts of the United States Treasury in conjunction with bank regulatory agencies to stimulate the economy and protect the financial system; inflation, interest rate, market, and monetary fluctuations; the timely development of and acceptance of new products and services offered by the Company as well as risks (including reputational and litigation) attendant thereto and the perceived overall value of these products and services by users; the risks of dealing with or utilizing third-party vendors; the scope of restrictions and compliance requirements imposed by the supervisory directives and/or the Consent Orders (as defined below) entered into by the Company and the Bank with the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”) and any other such actions which may be initiated; the impact of changes in financial services’ laws and regulations, including but not limited to our relationship with our new regulators, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) and the Federal Reserve; technological changes, including but not limited to the protection of electronic files or databases; acquisitions; litigation risk in general, including but not limited to those risks involving the MPS division; the growth of the Company’s business as well as expenses related thereto; changes in consumer spending and saving habits; and the success of the Company at managing and collecting assets of borrowers in default.

The foregoing list of factors is not exclusive. Additional discussions of factors affecting the Company’s business and prospects are contained in the Company’s periodic filings with the SEC. The Company expressly disclaims any intent or obligation to update any forward-looking statement, whether written or oral, that may be made from time to time by or on behalf of the Company or its subsidiaries.

Available Information

The Company’s website address is www.metabank.com. The Company makes available, through a link with the SEC’s EDGAR database, free of charge, its annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), and beneficial ownership reports on Forms 3, 4, and 5. The information found on the Company’s website is not incorporated by reference in this or any other report the Company files or furnishes to the SEC.

 
1


PART I

Business

General

Meta Financial, a registered unitary savings and loan holding company, is a Delaware corporation, the principal assets of which are all the issued and outstanding shares of the Bank, a federal savings bank. Meta Financial, on September 20, 1993, acquired all of the capital stock of the Bank in connection with its conversion from the mutual to stock form ownership. Unless the context otherwise requires, references herein to the Company include Meta Financial and the Bank, and all subsidiaries on a consolidated basis.

The Bank, the only direct, active full service banking subsidiary of Meta Financial, is a community-oriented financial institution offering a variety of financial services to meet the needs of the communities it serves and a payments company that provides services nationwide. The Bank provides a full range of financial services. The principal business of the Bank has historically consisted of attracting retail deposits from the general public and investing those funds primarily in one- to four-family residential mortgage loans, commercial and multi-family real estate, agricultural operations and real estate, construction, and consumer and commercial business loans primarily in the Bank’s market areas. Due to local economic factors, originations of commercial and multi-family real estate loans and commercial business loans continue to be lower when compared to prior years. The Bank also purchases loan participations from time to time from other financial institutions, but at a lower level compared to prior years, as well as mortgage-backed securities and other investments permissible under applicable regulations. In addition to its community-oriented lending and deposit gathering activities, in 2004, the Bank created a division known as Meta Payment Systems, or MPS, which issues various prepaid cards, consumer credit products, and sponsors ATMs into various debit networks and offers other payment industry products and services. MPS generates fee income and low- and no-cost deposits for the Bank through its activities. As noted in the “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, MPS expanded and played a significant role in the Company’s financial performance in fiscal 2010 and fiscal 2011.

The Company’s revenues are derived primarily from interest on commercial and residential mortgage loans, mortgage-backed securities, fees generated through the activities of MPS, other investments, consumer loans, agricultural operating loans, commercial business loans, income from service charges, loan origination fees, and loan servicing fee income.

Meta Financial owned Meta Trust Company (“Meta Trust”), a South Dakota trust corporation. Meta Trust, established in April 2002 as a South Dakota corporation and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Meta Financial, provided a full range of trust services. On September 30, 2010, the Company sold Meta Trust.

First Midwest Financial Capital Trust, also a wholly-owned subsidiary of Meta Financial, was established in July 2001 for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities.

Meta Financial and the Bank are subject to comprehensive regulation and supervision. See “Regulation” herein.

The home office of the Company is located at 121 East Fifth Street, Storm Lake, Iowa 50588. Its telephone number at that address is (712) 732-4117.

Market Areas

The Bank has four market areas and the MPS division: Northwest Iowa (“NWI”), Brookings, Central Iowa (“CI”), and Sioux Empire (“SE”). The Bank’s headquarters is located at 121 East Fifth Street in Storm Lake, Iowa. NWI operates two offices in Storm Lake, Iowa. Brookings operates one office in Brookings, South Dakota. CI operates a total of six offices in Iowa: Des Moines (3), West Des Moines (2) and Urbandale. SE operates three offices and one administrative office in Sioux Falls, SD. MPS, which offers prepaid cards and other payment industry products and services nationwide, operates out of Sioux Falls, South Dakota and has an administrative office in Omaha, Nebraska. See “Meta Payment Systems® Division.”

 
2


The Company has a total of twelve full-service branch offices, and one non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee.

The Company’s primary commercial banking market area includes the Iowa counties of Buena Vista, Dallas and Polk, and the South Dakota counties of Brookings, Lincoln, Minnehaha and Moody. Iowa ranks 10th and South Dakota 17th in “The Best States for Business and Careers” (Forbes.com, November 2011). Iowa has low corporate income and franchise taxes. South Dakota has no corporate income tax, personal income tax, personal property tax, business inventory tax, or inheritance tax.

Storm Lake is located in Iowa’s Buena Vista County approximately 150 miles northwest of Des Moines and 200 miles southwest of Minneapolis. Like much of the state of Iowa, Storm Lake and the surrounding market area are highly dependent upon farming and agricultural markets. Major employers in the area include Buena Vista Regional Medical Center, Tyson Foods, Sara Lee Foods, and Buena Vista University. The Northwest Iowa market operates two offices in Storm Lake.

Brookings is located in Brookings County, South Dakota, approximately 50 miles north of Sioux Falls and 200 miles west of Minneapolis. The Bank’s market area encompasses approximately a 60-mile radius of Brookings. The area is generally rural, and agriculture is a significant industry in the community. South Dakota State University is the largest employer in Brookings. The community also has several manufacturing companies, including 3M, Larson Manufacturing, Daktronics, Falcon Plastics, Twin City Fan, and Rainbow Play Systems, Inc. The Brookings market operates from an office located in downtown Brookings.

Des Moines, Iowa’s capital, is located in central Iowa. Des Moines was ranked 2nd in “The Best Places for Business and Careers” (Forbes.com, June 2011). The Des Moines market area encompasses Polk County and surrounding counties. The Bank’s Central Iowa main office is located in the heart of downtown Des Moines. The Urbandale office is in a high growth area just off I-80 at the intersection of two major streets. The West Des Moines office operates near a high-traffic intersection, across from a major shopping mall. The Ingersoll office is located near the heart of Des Moines, on a major thoroughfare, in a densely populated area. The Highland Park facility is located in a historical district approximately five minutes north of downtown Des Moines. The Jordan Creek office is located near Jordan Creek Town Center in West Des Moines, one of the fastest growing communities in the State of Iowa and the Greater Des Moines area. The Des Moines metro area is one of the top three insurance centers in the world, with sixty-seven insurance company headquarters and over one hundred regional insurance offices. Major employers include Principal Life Insurance Company, Iowa Health – Des Moines, Mercy Hospital Medical Center, Hy-Vee Food Stores, Inc., City of Des Moines, United Parcel Service, Nationwide Mutual Insurance Co., Pioneer Hi Bred International Inc., and Wells Fargo Financial and Home Mortgage. Universities and colleges in the area include Des Moines Area Community College, Drake University, Simpson College, Des Moines University – Osteopathic Medical Center, Grand View College, AIB College of Business, and Upper Iowa University. The unemployment rate in the Des Moines metro area was 5.6% as of September 2011.

Sioux Falls is located at the crossroads of Interstates 29 and 90 in southeast South Dakota, 270 miles southwest of Minneapolis. The Sioux Falls market area encompasses Minnehaha and Lincoln counties. The main branch is located at the high growth area of 57th and Western. Other branches are located at 33rd and Minnesota and the intersection of 12th and Elmwood. On Forbes’ July 2011 list of “The Best Places for Business and Careers,” Sioux Falls ranked No. 2 among the best small cities. Major employers in the area include Sanford Health, Avera McKennan Hospital, John Morrell & Company, Citibank (South Dakota) NA, and Hy-Vee Food Stores. Sioux Falls is home to Augustana College and The University of Sioux Falls. The unemployment rate in Sioux Falls was 4.1% as of September 2011.

Several of the Company’s market areas are dependent on agriculture and agriculture-related businesses, which are exposed to exogenous risk factors such as weather conditions and commodity prices. Presently, economic conditions in the agricultural sector of the Company’s market area are stronger than they have been for several years. Crop yields in 2011 were variable due to the abnormally wet spring followed by an extremely hot and dry July. Overall, in the Company’s market areas, most crop yields were still average to above average. Near record crop and livestock prices in 2011 led to near record farm income, pushing farmland prices to all-time highs in the Company’s market areas. The agricultural economy is accustomed to commodity price fluctuations and is generally able to handle such fluctuations without significant problems. Although there has been minimal effect observed to date, an extended period of low commodity prices, higher input costs or poor weather conditions could result in reduced profit margins in the agricultural sector, thus reducing demand for goods and services provided by agriculture-related businesses. This could also affect other businesses in the Company’s market area.

 
3


Lending Activities

General. Historically, the Company originated fixed-rate, one- to four-family mortgage loans. In the early 1980s, the Company began to focus on the origination of adjustable-rate mortgage (“ARM”) loans and short-term loans for retention in its portfolio in order to increase the percentage of loans in its portfolio with more frequent repricing or shorter maturities, and in some cases higher yields, than fixed-rate residential mortgage loans. While the Company still originates ARM loans, more recently it has pursued fixed-rate residential mortgage loan originations in response to consumer demand. Most such loans are generally sold in the secondary market. At September 30, 2011, the Company had $237.8 million in fixed-rate loans, and $81.6 million in adjustable rate loans. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on Asset/Liability Management.

In addition, the Company has more recently focused its lending activities on the origination of commercial and multi-family real estate loans and, to a lesser extent, commercial business loans. The Company also continues to originate one-to-four family mortgage loans, consumer loans and agriculturally related loans. The Company originates most of its loans in its primary market area. At September 30, 2011, the Company’s net loan portfolio totaled $314.4 million, or 24.6% of the Company’s total assets, as compared to $366.0 million, or 35.6% at September 30, 2010.

Loan applications are initially considered and approved at various levels of authority, depending on the type and amount of the loan. The Company has a loan committee consisting of senior lenders and Market Presidents, and is led by the Chief Lending Officer. Loans in excess of certain amounts require approval by at least two members of the entire loan committee, a majority of the entire loan committee, or by the Company’s Board Loan Committee, which has responsibility for the overall supervision of the loan portfolio. The Company reserves the right to discontinue, adjust or create new lending programs to respond to competitive factors.

At September 30, 2011, the Company’s largest lending relationship to a single borrower or group of related borrowers totaled $7.7 million. The Company had 24 other lending relationships in excess of $3.3 million as of September 30, 2011. At September 30, 2011, three of these loans totaling $14.8 million were classified as substandard. See “Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern, and Classified Assets.”

 
4


Loan Portfolio Composition. The following table provides information about the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio in dollar amounts and in percentages (before deductions for loans in process, deferred fees and discounts and allowances for losses) as of the dates indicated. Balances related to discontinued bank operations have been eliminated for all periods presented.

   
At September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
         
2008
         
2007
       
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                                             
Real Estate Loans:
                                                           
1-4 Family
  $ 34,128       10.7 %   $ 40,454       10.9 %   $ 48,506       12.2 %   $ 55,669       13.0 %   $ 45,153       12.6 %
Commercial & Multi Family
    194,414       60.9 %     204,820       55.1 %     232,750       58.4 %     222,651       51.2 %     169,877       47.1 %
Agricultural
    20,320       6.4 %     25,895       7.0 %     26,755       6.7 %     30,046       6.9 %     16,582       4.6 %
Total Real Estate Loans
    248,862       78.0 %     271,169       73.1 %     308,011       77.3 %     308,366       71.1 %     231,612       64.3 %
                                                                                 
Other Loans:
                                                                               
Consumer Loans:
                                                                               
Home Equity
    14,835       4.6 %     16,897       4.5 %     18,555       4.7 %     21,353       4.9 %     23,832       6.6 %
Automobile
    794       0.2 %     737       0.2 %     928       0.2 %     922       0.2 %     1,241       0.4 %
Other (1)
    18,769       5.9 %     30,479       8.2 %     16,516       4.1 %     27,054       6.3 %     11,690       3.2 %
Total Consumer Loans
    34,398       10.7 %     48,113       13.0 %     35,999       9.0 %     49,329       11.4 %     36,763       10.2 %
                                                                                 
Agricultural Operating
    21,200       6.6 %     32,528       8.8 %     27,889       7.0 %     31,153       7.2 %     33,143       9.2 %
Commercial Business
    14,955       4.7 %     19,709       5.3 %     26,869       6.7 %     44,972       10.3 %     58,705       16.3 %
                                                                                 
Total Other Loans
    70,553       22.0 %     100,350       26.9 %     90,757       22.7 %     125,454       28.9 %     128,611       35.7 %
Total Loans
    319,415       100.0 %     371,519       100.0 %     398,768       100.0 %     433,820       100.0 %     360,223       100.0 %
                                                                                 
Less:
                                                                               
Deferred Fees and Discounts
    79               240               166               160               117          
Allowance for Loan Losses
    4,926               5,234               6,993               5,732               4,493          
                                                                                 
Total Loans Receivable, Net
  $ 314,410             $ 366,045             $ 391,609             $ 427,928             $ 355,613          
 

 
(1)
Consist generally of various types of secured and unsecured consumer loans.

 
5


The following table shows the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio by fixed and adjustable rate at the dates indicated. Balances related to discontinued bank operations have been eliminated for all periods presented.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                                             
Fixed Rate Loans:
                                                           
Real Estate:
                                                           
1-4 Family
  $ 30,410       9.5 %   $ 34,513       9.3 %   $ 42,310       10.6 %   $ 42,952       9.9 %   $ 34,157       9.5 %
Commercial & Multi Family
    155,786       48.8 %     163,843       44.0 %     180,891       45.3 %     171,114       39.4 %     128,495       35.6 %
Agricultural
    16,416       5.1 %     16,937       4.6 %     17,317       4.4 %     20,262       4.6 %     11,610       3.2 %
Total Fixed-Rate Real Estate Loans
    202,612       63.4 %     215,293       57.9 %     240,518       60.3 %     234,328       53.9 %     174,262       48.3 %
Consumer
    15,494       4.9 %     19,066       5.1 %     17,398       4.4 %     42,192       9.7 %     21,470       6.0 %
Agricultural Operating
    12,570       3.9 %     22,490       6.0 %     15,752       3.9 %     16,840       3.9 %     16,519       4.6 %
Commercial Business
    7,138       2.3 %     11,147       3.1 %     15,576       3.9 %     25,224       5.8 %     31,386       8.7 %
Total Fixed-Rate Loans
    237,814       74.5 %     267,996       72.1 %     289,244       72.5 %     318,584       73.3 %     243,637       67.6 %
                                                                                 
Adjustable Rate Loans:
                                                                               
Real Estate:
                                                                               
1-4 Family
    3,718       1.2 %     5,941       1.6 %     6,196       1.6 %     12,717       2.9 %     10,996       3.1 %
Commercial & Multi Family
    38,628       12.1 %     40,977       11.0 %     51,859       13.0 %     51,537       11.9 %     41,382       11.5 %
Agricultural
    3,904       1.2 %     8,958       2.5 %     9,438       2.4 %     9,784       2.3 %     4,972       1.4 %
Total Adjustable Real Estate Loans
    46,250       14.5 %     55,876       15.1 %     67,493       17.0 %     74,038       17.1 %     57,350       16.0 %
Consumer
    18,904       5.9 %     29,047       7.8 %     18,601       4.7 %     7,137       1.7 %     15,293       4.2 %
Agricultural Operating
    8,630       2.7 %     10,038       2.7 %     12,137       3.0 %     14,313       3.3 %     16,624       4.6 %
Commercial Business
    7,817       2.4 %     8,562       2.3 %     11,293       2.8 %     19,748       4.6 %     27,319       7.6 %
Total Adjustable Loans
    81,601       25.5 %     103,523       27.9 %     109,524       27.5 %     115,236       26.7 %     116,586       32.4 %
Total Loans
    319,415       100.0 %     371,519       100.0 %     398,768       100.0 %     433,820       100.0 %     360,223       100.0 %
                                                                                 
Less:
                                                                               
Deferred Fees and Discounts
    79               240               166               160               117          
Allowance for Loan Losses
    4,926               5,234               6,993               5,732               4,493          
                                                                                 
Total Loans Receivable, Net
  $ 314,410             $ 366,045             $ 391,609             $ 427,928             $ 355,613          

 
6


The following table illustrates the interest rate sensitivity of the Company’s loan portfolio at September 30, 2011. Mortgages which have adjustable or renegotiable interest rates are shown as maturing in the period during which the contract reprices. The table reflects management’s estimate of the effects of loan prepayments or curtailments based on data from the Company’s historical experiences and other third party sources.

     
Real Estate (1)
   
Consumer
   
Commercial Business
   
Agricultural Operating
   
Total
 
     
Amount
   
Weighted Average Rate
   
Amount
   
Weighted Average Rate
   
Amount
   
Weighted Average Rate
   
Amount
   
Weighted Average Rate
   
Amount
   
Weighted Average Rate
 
     
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                                               
Due During Years
                                                             
Ending September 30,
                                                             
                                                               
2012 (2)
    $ 19,705       5.27 %   $ 8,156       5.39 %   $ 5,564       4.93 %   $ 15,211       5.30 %   $ 48,636       5.26 %
2013-2014       55,436       5.93 %     4,990       5.77 %     5,256       5.26 %     2,239       5.97 %     67,921       5.87 %
2015 and following
      173,721       6.03 %     21,252       6.31 %     4,135       6.28 %     3,750       5.32 %     202,858       6.05 %
Total
    $ 248,862             $ 34,398             $ 14,955             $ 21,200             $ 319,415          
_______________________
(1)
Includes one-to-four family, multi family, commercial and agricultural real estate loans.
(2)
Includes demand loans, loans having no stated maturity and overdraft loans.

 
7


One- to Four-Family Residential Mortgage Lending. One- to four-family residential mortgage loan originations are generated by the Company’s marketing efforts, its present customers, walk-in customers and referrals. At September 30, 2011, the Company’s one- to four-family residential mortgage loan portfolio totaled $34.1 million, or 11% of the Company’s total gross loan portfolio. See “Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans and Mortgage-Backed Securities.” At September 30, 2011, the average outstanding principal balance of a one- to four-family residential mortgage loan was approximately $61,000.

The Company offers fixed-rate and ARM loans for both permanent structures and those under construction. During the year ended September 30, 2011, the Company originated $4.8 million of adjustable-rate loans and $33.6 million of fixed-rate loans secured by one- to four-family residential real estate. The Company’s one- to four-family residential mortgage originations are secured primarily by properties located in its primary market area and surrounding areas.

The Company originates one- to four-family residential mortgage loans with terms up to a maximum of 30-years and with loan-to-value ratios up to 100% of the lesser of the appraised value of the security property or the contract price. The Company generally requires that private mortgage insurance be obtained in an amount sufficient to reduce the Company’s exposure to at or below the 80% loan-to-value level, unless the loan is insured by the Federal Housing Administration, guaranteed by Veterans Affairs or guaranteed by the Rural Housing Administration. Residential loans generally do not include prepayment penalties.

The Company currently offers one, three, five, seven and ten year ARM loans. These loans have a fixed-rate for the stated period and, thereafter, such loans adjust annually. These loans generally provide for an annual cap of up to a 200 basis points and a lifetime cap of 600 basis points over the initial rate. As a consequence of using an initial fixed-rate and caps, the interest rates on these loans may not be as rate sensitive as is the Company's cost of funds. The Company’s ARMs do not permit negative amortization of principal and are not convertible into a fixed rate loan. The Company’s delinquency experience on its ARM loans has generally been similar to its experience on fixed rate residential loans. Current market conditions make ARM loans unattractive and very few are originated.

Due to consumer demand, the Company also offers fixed-rate mortgage loans with terms up to 30 years, most of which conform to secondary market, i.e., Fannie Mae, Ginnie Mae, and Freddie Mac standards. Interest rates charged on these fixed-rate loans are competitively priced according to market conditions. The Company currently sells most, but not all, of its fixed-rate loans with terms greater than 15 years.

In underwriting one- to four-family residential real estate loans, the Company evaluates both the borrower’s ability to make monthly payments and the value of the property securing the loan. Properties securing real estate loans made by the Company are appraised by independent appraisers approved by the Board of Directors. The Company generally requires borrowers to obtain an attorney’s title opinion or title insurance, and fire and property insurance (including flood insurance, if necessary) in an amount not less than the amount of the loan. Real estate loans originated by the Company generally contain a “due on sale” clause allowing the Company to declare the unpaid principal balance due and payable upon the sale of the security property. The Company has not engaged in sub-prime residential mortgage originations.

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate Lending. The Company engages in commercial and multi-family real estate lending in its primary market area and surrounding areas and, in order to supplement its loan portfolio, has purchased whole loan and participation interests in loans from other financial institutions. At September 30, 2011, the Company’s commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio totaled $194.4 million, or 61% of the Company’s total gross loan portfolio. The purchased loans and loan participation interests are generally secured by properties located in the Midwest and West. See “Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans and Mortgage-Backed Securities.” The Company purchased $5.5 million, $4.8 million, and $41.7 million, of such loans during fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. At September 30, 2011, $13.0 million, or 6.7% of the Company’s commercial and multi-family real estate loans, was non-performing. See “Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern and Classified Assets.”

The Company’s commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio is secured primarily by apartment buildings, office buildings, and hotels. Commercial and multi-family real estate loans generally have terms that do not exceed 20 years, have loan-to-value ratios of up to 80% of the appraised value of the security property, and are typically secured by personal guarantees of the borrowers. The Company has a variety of rate adjustment features and other terms in its commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio. Commercial and multi-family real estate loans provide for a margin over a number of different indices. In underwriting these loans, the Company currently analyzes the financial condition of the borrower, the borrower’s credit history, and the reliability and predictability of the cash flow generated by the property securing the loan. Appraisals on properties securing commercial real estate loans originated by the Company are performed by independent appraisers.

 
8


At September 30, 2011, the Company’s largest commercial and multi-family real estate loan was a $7.7 million loan secured by real estate. At September 30, 2011, the average outstanding principal balance of a commercial or multi-family real estate loan held by the Company was approximately $698,000.

Commercial and multi-family real estate loans generally present a higher level of risk than loans secured by one- to four-family residences. This greater risk is due to several factors, including the concentration of principal in a limited number of loans and borrowers, the effect of general economic conditions on income producing properties and the increased difficulty of evaluating and monitoring these types of loans. Furthermore, the repayment of loans secured by commercial and multi-family real estate is typically dependent upon the successful operation of the related real estate project. If the cash flow from the project is reduced (for example, if leases are not obtained or renewed, or a bankruptcy court modifies a lease term, or a major tenant is unable to fulfill its lease obligations), the borrower's ability to repay the loan may be impaired. At September 30, 2011, the Bank’s nonresidential real estate loans totaled 195% of risk-based capital.

Agricultural Lending. The Company originates loans to finance the purchase of farmland, livestock, farm machinery and equipment, seed, fertilizer and other farm related products. At September 30, 2011, the Company had agricultural real estate loans secured by farmland of $20.3 million or 6% of the Company’s gross loan portfolio. At the same date, $21.2 million, or 7% of the Company’s gross loan portfolio, consisted of secured loans related to agricultural operations. Agricultural related lending constituted 13% of the gross loan portfolio.

Agricultural operating loans are originated at either an adjustable or fixed rate of interest for up to a one year term or, in the case of livestock, upon sale. Most agricultural operating loans have terms of one year or less. Such loans provide for payments of principal and interest at least annually or a lump sum payment upon maturity if the original term is less than one year. Loans secured by agricultural machinery are generally originated as fixed-rate loans with terms of up to seven years. At September 30, 2011, the average outstanding principal balance of an agricultural operating loan held by the Company was $112,000. At September 30, 2011, none of the Company’s agricultural operating loans was non-performing.

Agricultural real estate loans are frequently originated with adjustable rates of interest. Generally, such loans provide for a fixed rate of interest for the first one to five years, which then balloon or adjust annually thereafter. In addition, such loans generally amortize over a period of ten to 20 years. Adjustable-rate agricultural real estate loans provide for a margin over the yields on the corresponding U.S. Treasury security or prime rate. Fixed-rate agricultural real estate loans generally have terms up to five years. Agricultural real estate loans are generally limited to 75% of the value of the property securing the loan. At September 30, 2011, none of the Company’s agricultural real estate portfolio was non-performing.

Agricultural lending affords the Company the opportunity to earn yields higher than those obtainable on one- to four-family residential lending. Nevertheless, agricultural lending involves a greater degree of risk than one- to four-family residential mortgage loans because of the typically larger loan amount. In addition, payments on loans are dependent on the successful operation or management of the farm property securing the loan or for which an operating loan is utilized. The success of the loan may also be affected by many factors outside the control of the farm borrower.

Weather presents one of the greatest risks as hail, drought, floods, or other conditions, can severely limit crop yields and thus impair loan repayments and the value of the underlying collateral. This risk can be reduced by the farmer with a variety of insurance coverages which can help to ensure loan repayment. Government support programs and the Company generally require that farmers procure crop insurance coverage. Grain and livestock prices also present a risk as prices may decline prior to sale resulting in a failure to cover production costs. These risks may be reduced by the farmer with the use of futures contracts or options to mitigate price risk. The Company frequently requires borrowers to use future contracts or options to reduce price risk and help ensure loan repayment. Another risk is the uncertainty of government programs and other regulations. During periods of low commodity prices, the income from government programs can be a significant source of cash to make loan payments and if these programs are discontinued or significantly changed, cash flow problems or defaults could result. Finally, many farms are dependent on a limited number of key individuals upon whose injury or death may result in an inability to successfully operate the farm.

 
9


Consumer Lending- Retail Bank. The “Retail Bank” (generally referring to operations in our four market areas discussed earlier) offers a variety of secured consumer loans, including home equity, home improvement, automobile, boat and loans secured by savings deposits. In addition, the Retail Bank offers other secured and unsecured consumer loans. The Retail Bank currently originates most of its consumer loans in its primary market area and surrounding areas. The Retail Bank originates consumer loans on both a direct and indirect basis. At September 30, 2011, the Retail Bank’s consumer loan portfolio totaled $18.2 million, or 6% of its total gross loan portfolio. Of the consumer loan portfolio at September 30, 2011, $11.4 million were short- and intermediate-term, fixed-rate loans, while $6.8 million were adjustable-rate loans.

The largest component of the Retail Bank’s consumer loan portfolio consists of home equity loans and lines of credit. Substantially all of the Retail Bank’s home equity loans and lines of credit are secured by second mortgages on principal residences. The Retail Bank will lend amounts which, together with all prior liens, typically may be up to 100% of the appraised value of the property securing the loan. Home equity loans and lines of credit generally have maximum terms of five years.

The Retail Bank primarily originates automobile loans on a direct basis. Direct loans are loans made when the Retail Bank extends credit directly to the borrower, as opposed to indirect loans, which are made when the Retail Bank purchases loan contracts, often at a discount, from automobile dealers which have extended credit to their customers. The Retail Bank’s automobile loans typically are originated at fixed interest rates with terms up to 60 months for new and used vehicles. Loans secured by automobiles are generally originated for up to 80% of the N.A.D.A. book value of the automobile securing the loan.

Consumer loan terms vary according to the type and value of collateral, length of contract and creditworthiness of the borrower. The underwriting standards employed by the Company for consumer loans include an application, a determination of the applicant’s payment history on other debts and an assessment of ability to meet existing obligations and payments on the proposed loan. Although creditworthiness of the applicant is a primary consideration, the underwriting process also includes a comparison of the value of the security, if any, in relation to the proposed loan amount.

Consumer loans may entail greater credit risk than do residential mortgage loans, particularly in the case of consumer loans which are unsecured or are secured by rapidly depreciable assets, such as automobiles or recreational equipment. In such cases, any repossessed collateral for a defaulted consumer loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment of the outstanding loan balance as a result of the greater likelihood of damage, loss or depreciation. In addition, consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower’s continuing financial stability, and thus are more likely to be affected by adverse personal circumstances. Furthermore, the application of various federal and state laws, including bankruptcy and insolvency laws, may limit the amount which can be recovered on such loans. At September 30, 2011, none of the Company’s consumer loan portfolio was non-performing.

Consumer Lending - MPS. MPS has a loan committee consisting of members of Executive Management. This committee, known as the MPS Credit Committee (the “Committee”), is charged with monitoring, evaluating, and reporting portfolio performance and the overall credit risk posed by its credit products. All proposed credit programs must first be reviewed and approved by the Committee before such programs are presented to the Company’s Board of Directors for approval. The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for final approval of any credit program. Among other things, under the terms of a Consent Order, the Bank, absent prior permission from its primary federal regulator, may not originate tax refund anticipation loans or offer a tax refund processing service. See “Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

 
10


At September 30, 2011, MPS’ consumer loan portfolio totaled $16.2 million, or 5% of the Company’s total gross loan portfolio. Of the consumer loan portfolio at September 30, 2011, $4.1 million were short- and intermediate-term, fixed-rate loans, while $12.1 million were adjustable-rate loans.

The Company believes that well-managed, nationwide credit programs can help meet legitimate credit needs for prime and sub-prime borrowers, and affords the Company an opportunity to diversify the loan portfolio and minimize earnings exposure due to economic downturns. Therefore, subject to the Consent Order, MPS designs and administers certain credit programs that seek to accomplish these objectives. For a summary of the Consent Orders and related matters; see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

MPS has strived to offer consumers innovative payment products, including credit products. Most credit products have fallen into one of two general categories: (1) sponsorship lending and (2) portfolio lending. In a sponsorship lending model, MPS typically originates loans and sells (without recourse) the resulting receivables to third party investors equipped to take the associated credit risk. MPS’s sponsorship lending programs are governed by the Policy for Sponsorship Lending which has been approved by the Board of Directors. A Portfolio Credit Policy which has been approved by the Board of Directors governs portfolio credit initiatives undertaken by MPS, whereby the Company retains some or all receivables and relies on the borrower as the underlying source of repayment. Several portfolio lending programs also have a contractual provision that has indemnified MPS and the Bank for credit losses that meet or exceed predetermined levels. Such a program carries additional risks not commonly found in sponsorship programs, specifically funding and credit risk. Therefore, MPS has strived to employ policies, procedures, and information systems that are commensurate with the added risk and exposure. Due to supervisory directives issued by our regulator, an MPS lending program - iAdvance – was eliminated effective October 13, 2010. In addition, our third party relationship programs have been limited to third party relationships in existence at the time the directives were issued, absent prior approval to engage in new relationships. For additional discussion, see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

The Company recognizes that concentrations of credit may naturally occur and may take the form of a large volume of related loans to an individual, a specific industry, a geographic location, or an occupation. Credit concentration is a direct, indirect, or contingent obligation that has a common bond where the aggregate exposure equals or exceeds a certain percentage of the Bank’s Tier 1 Capital plus the Allowance for Loan Losses.

The MPS Credit Committee monitors and identifies the credit concentrations and evaluates the specific nature of each concentration to determine the potential risk to the Bank. An evaluation includes the following:

 
·
A recommendation regarding additional controls needed to mitigate the concentration exposure.

 
·
A limitation or cap placed on the size of the concentration.

 
·
The potential necessity of increased capital and/or credit reserves to cover the increased risk caused by the concentration(s).

 
·
A strategy to reduce to acceptable levels those concentration(s) that are determined to create undue risk to the Bank.

Pursuant to the terms of its Consent Order, the Bank adopted a new concentration policy including enhanced risk analysis, monitoring and management for its respective concentration limits.

Commercial Business Lending. The Company also originates commercial business loans. Most of the Company’s commercial business loans have been extended to finance local and regional businesses and include short-term loans to finance machinery and equipment purchases, inventory and accounts receivable. Commercial loans also involve the extension of revolving credit for a combination of equipment acquisitions and working capital in expanding companies. At September 30, 2011, $15.0 million, or 5% of the Company’s total gross loan portfolio, was comprised of commercial business loans.

 
11


The maximum term for loans extended on machinery and equipment is based on the projected useful life of such machinery and equipment. Generally, the maximum term on non-mortgage lines of credit is one year. The loan-to-value ratio on such loans and lines of credit generally may not exceed 80% of the value of the collateral securing the loan. The Company’s commercial business lending policy includes credit file documentation and analysis of the borrower’s character, capacity to repay the loan, the adequacy of the borrower’s capital and collateral as well as an evaluation of conditions affecting the borrower. Analysis of the borrower’s past, present and future cash flows is also an important aspect of the Company’s current credit analysis. Nonetheless, such loans are believed to carry higher credit risk than more traditional investments.

The largest commercial business loan outstanding at September 30, 2011 was a $4.4 million loan secured by assets of the borrower. The next largest commercial business loan outstanding at September 30, 2011 was a $3.5 million loan secured by assets of the borrower. At September 30, 2011, the average outstanding principal balance of a commercial business loan held by the Company was approximately $76,000.

Unlike residential mortgage loans, which generally are made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from his or her employment and other income and which are secured by real property whose value tends to be more easily ascertainable, commercial business loans typically are made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from the cash flow of the borrower’s business. As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of commercial business loans may be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself (which, in turn, is likely to be dependent upon the general economic environment). The Company’s commercial business loans are usually, but not always, secured by business assets and personal guarantees. However, the collateral securing the loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business. At September 30, 2011, $30,000, or 0.2%, of the Company’s commercial business loan portfolio was non-performing. Commercial business loans have been a declining percentage of the Company’s loan portfolio since 2005.

Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans

Loans are generally originated by the Company’s staff of loan officers. Loan applications are taken and processed in the branches and the main office of the Company. While the Company originates both adjustable-rate and fixed-rate loans, its ability to originate loans is dependent upon the relative customer demand for loans in its market. Demand is affected by the interest rate and economic environment.

The Company, from time to time, sells whole loans and loan participations, generally without recourse. At September 30, 2011, there were no loans outstanding sold with recourse. When loans are sold, the Company sometimes retains the responsibility for collecting and remitting loan payments, making certain that real estate tax payments are made on behalf of borrowers, and otherwise servicing the loans. The servicing fee is recognized as income over the life of the loans. The Company services loans that it originated and sold totaling $24.8 million at September 30, 2011, of which $16.0 million were sold to Fannie Mae and $8.8 million were sold to others.

In periods of economic uncertainty, the Company’s ability to originate large dollar volumes of loans may be substantially reduced or restricted, with a resultant decrease in related loan origination fees, other fee income and operating earnings. In addition, the Company’s ability to sell loans may substantially decrease as potential buyers (principally government agencies) reduce their purchasing activities.

The following table shows the loan originations (including undisbursed portions of loans in process), purchases, and sales and repayment activities of the Company for the periods indicated. During fiscal 2011, MPS increased sponsorship lending activity by $445 million under two programs due primarily to originating loans under these programs for the full fiscal year as compared to a partial year in fiscal 2010. This increase in volume was partially offset by a decrease in iAdvance loans, which caused the Non-Real Estate Consumer loan originations to decrease in fiscal 2011. During fiscal 2010, the Company originated $415 million of iAdvance loans as compared to only $18 million during fiscal year 2011 as the Company ceased making iAdvance loans on October 13, 2010.

 
12


   
Years Ended September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Originations by Type:
                 
Adjustable Rate:
                 
Real Estate - 1-4 Family
  $ 4,793     $ 4,298     $ 5,783  
-Commercial and Multi-Family
    3,169       18,157       13,168  
-Agricultural Real Estate
    2,242       3,012       6,847  
Non-Real Estate - Consumer
    6,219       10,612       60,393  
-Commercial Business
    22,492       20,020       27,224  
-Agricultural Operating
    31,318       20,345       22,374  
Total Adjustable Rate
    70,233       76,444       135,789  
                         
Fixed Rate:
                       
Real Estate - 1-4 Family
    33,563       28,007       49,566  
-Commercial and Multi-Family
    28,282       45,863       43,688  
-Agricultural Real Estate
    9,158       4,133       3,106  
Non-Real Estate - Consumer
    969,203       984,415       405,001  
-Commercial Business
    3,444       7,797       9,471  
-Agricultural Operating
    49,883       54,760       39,512  
Total Fixed-Rate
    1,093,533       1,124,975       550,344  
Total Loans Originated
    1,163,766       1,201,419       686,133  
                         
Purchases:
                       
Real Estate - 1-4 Family
    -       -       1,116  
-Commercial and Multi-Family
    5,523       4,795       41,745  
- Agricultural Real Estate
    61       392       7,497  
Non-Real Estate - Commercial Business
    -       400       -  
- Agricultural Operating
    236       3,343       -  
Total Loans Purchased
    5,820       8,930       50,358  
                         
                         
Sales and Repayments:
                       
Sales:
                       
Real Estate - 1-4 Family
    3,439       2,383       3,158  
Real Estate - Commercial and Multi-Family
    -       505       -  
Non-Real Estate - Consumer
    894,605       804,171       268,730  
Total Loan Sales
    898,044       807,059       271,888  
                         
Repayments:
                       
Loan Principal Repayments
    324,128       430,321       500,084  
Total Principal Repayments
    324,128       430,321       500,084  
Total Reductions
    1,222,172       1,237,380       771,972  
                         
Increase (decrease) in other items, net
    951       1,467       (838 )
Net Decrease
  $ (51,635 )   $ (25,564 )   $ (36,319 )

 
13


At September 30, 2011, approximately $23.2 million, or 7.3%, of the Company’s gross loan portfolio consisted of purchased loans. The Company believes that purchasing loans outside of its market area assists the Company in diversifying its portfolio and may lessen the adverse affects on the Company’s business or operations which could result in the event of a downturn or weakening of the local economy in which the Company conducts its primary operations. However, additional risks are associated with purchasing loans outside of the Company’s market area, including the lack of knowledge of the local market and difficulty in monitoring and inspecting the property securing the loans.

At September 30, 2011, the Company’s purchased loans were secured by properties located, as a percentage of total loans, as follows: 2% in Iowa and Oregon, 1% each in Washington and Minnesota and the remaining 1% in seven other states.

Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern, and Classified Assets

When a borrower fails to make a required payment on real estate secured loans and consumer loans within 16 days after the payment is due, the Company generally initiates collection procedures by mailing a delinquency notice. The customer is contacted again, by written notice or telephone, before the payment is 30 days past due and again before 60 days past due. Generally, delinquencies are cured promptly; however, if a loan has been delinquent for more than 90 days, satisfactory payment arrangements must be adhered to or the Company will initiate foreclosure or repossession.

The following table sets forth the Company’s loan delinquencies by type, before allowance for loan losses, by amount and by percentage of type at September 30, 2011.

   
Loans Delinquent For:
 
   
30-59 Days
   
60-89 Days
   
90 Days and Over
 
               
Percent
               
Percent
               
Percent
 
               
of
               
of
               
of
 
   
Number
   
Amount
   
Category
   
Number
   
Amount
   
Category
   
Number
   
Amount
   
Category
 
                     
(Dollars in Thousands)
                   
Real Estate:
                                                     
1-4 Family
    1     $ 51       2.0 %     1     $ 30       68.2 %     6     $ 127       1.4 %
Commercial & Multi-Family
    1       2,460       97.0 %     -       -       0.0 %     4       9,075       98.4 %
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %
Consumer
    2       26       1.0 %     1       14       31.8 %     1       24       0.2 %
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %
Commercial Business
    -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %     -       -       0.0 %
Total
    4     $ 2,537       100.0 %     2     $ 44       100.0 %     11     $ 9,226       100.0 %

Delinquencies 90 days and over constituted 2.9% of total gross loans and 0.7% of total assets.

Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent 90 days or more or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is taken out of current income. The loan will remain on a non-accrual status until the loan becomes current. For all years presented, the Company’s troubled debt restructurings (which involved forgiving a portion of interest or principal on any loans or making loans at a rate materially less than that of market rates) are included in the table and were performing as agreed.

The table below sets forth the amounts and categories of non-performing assets in the Company’s loan portfolio. Balances related to the sale of a bank subsidiary in March 2008 treated as discontinued bank operations have been eliminated for all periods presented.

 
14


   
At September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
Non-Performing Loans
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                               
Non-Accruing Loans:
                             
1-4 Family
  $ 85     $ 39     $ 266     $ 942     $ 243  
Commercial & Multi Family
    13,025       4,137       11,512       1,302       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       2,650       -       12       13  
Consumer
    -       -       -       1       5  
Agricultural Operating
    -       400       -       -       -  
Commercial Business
    30       241       871       538       1,867  
Total
    13,140       7,467       12,649       2,795       2,128  
                                         
Accruing Loans Delinquent 90 Days or More:
                                       
1-4 Family
    -       404       -       -       -  
Commercial & Multi Family
    -       257       -       -       -  
Consumer
    24       124       -       -       -  
Commercial Business
    -       -       -       4,600       -  
Total
    24       785       -       4,600       -  
                                         
Restructured Loans:
                                       
1-4 Family
    42       -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       121       150  
Commercial Business
    -       -       -       -       15  
Total
    42       -       -       121       165  
                                         
Total Non-Performing Loans
    13,206       8,252       12,649       7,516       2,293  
                                         
Other Assets
                                       
                                         
Non-Accruing Investments:
                                       
Trust Preferred Securities
    -       150       -       -       -  
Total
    -       150       -       -       -  
                                         
Foreclosed Assets:
                                       
1-4 Family
    451       143       -       -       -  
Commercial & Multi Family
    181       606       957       -       229  
Agricultural Real Estate
    2,020       -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       -       24  
Commercial Business
    19       546       1,096       -       65  
Total
    2,671       1,295       2,053       -       318  
                                         
Total Other Assets
    2,671       1,445       2,053       -       318  
                                         
Total Non-Performing Assets
  $ 15,877     $ 9,697     $ 14,702     $ 7,516     $ 2,611  
Total as a Percentage of Total Assets
    1.24 %     0.94 %     1.76 %     1.06 %     0.38 %

 
15


For the year ended September 30, 2011, gross interest income which would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to approximately $1.5 million, of which none was included in interest income.

Non-Accruing Loans. At September 30, 2011, the Company had $13.2 million in non-accruing loans, which constituted 4.1% of the Company’s gross loan portfolio, or 1.0% of total assets. At September 30, 2010, the Company had $7.5 million in non-accruing loans which constituted 2.0% of its gross loan portfolio, or 0.8% of total assets. The fiscal 2011 increase in non-performing loans relates to an increase in non-accruing loans in the commercial and multifamily category from $4.1 million to $13.0 million. There are 5 commercial and multi-family loans in non-accrual status at September 30, 2011.

Accruing Loans Delinquent 90 Days or More. At September 30, 2011, the Company had $24,000 in accruing loans delinquent 90 days or more.

Classified Assets. Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans and other assets such as debt and equity securities considered by our regulator, the OCC, to be of lesser quality as “substandard,” “doubtful” or “loss.” An asset is considered “substandard” if it is inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. “Substandard” assets include those characterized by the “distinct possibility” that the savings association will sustain “some loss” if the deficiencies are not corrected. Assets classified as “doubtful” have all of the weaknesses inherent in those classified “substandard,” with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make “collection or liquidation in full,” on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, “highly questionable and improbable.” Assets classified as “loss” are those considered “uncollectible” and of such minimal value that their continuance as assets without the establishment of a specific loss reserve is not warranted.

General allowances represent loss allowances which have been established to recognize the inherent risk associated with lending activities, but which, unlike specific allowances, have not been allocated to particular problem assets. When assets are classified as “loss,” the Bank is required either to establish a specific allowance for losses equal to 100% of that portion of the asset so classified or to charge-off such amount. The Banks’ determinations as to the classification of their assets and the amount of their valuation allowances are subject to review by their regulatory authorities, who may order the establishment of additional general or specific loss allowances.

On the basis of management’s review of its assets, at September 30, 2011, the Company had classified a total of $42.7 million of its assets as substandard, $60,000 as doubtful and none as loss. There were $2.7 million real estate owned or other foreclosed assets at September 30, 2011.

Allowance for Loan Losses. The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan losses based on management’s evaluation of the risk inherent in its loan portfolio and changes in the nature and volume of its loan activity, including those loans which are being specifically monitored by management. Such evaluation, which includes a review of loans for which full collectibility may not be reasonably assured, considers, among other matters, the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral, economic conditions, historical loan loss experience and other factors that warrant recognition in providing for an adequate loan loss allowance.

Management closely monitors economic developments both regionally and nationwide, and considers these factors when assessing the adequacy of its allowance for loan losses. While the Company has no direct exposure to sub-prime mortgage loans, management recognizes that the current slow economic recovery may continue to strain the financial condition of some borrowers. Management therefore believes that future losses in the residential portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. Concerns regarding the recovery, have led management to the conclusion that future losses in its commercial and multi-family and commercial business portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. On the other hand, current trends in agricultural markets remain reasonable. Reasonable commodity prices and yields created positive economic conditions for most farmers in our markets in 2011. Nonetheless, management still expects that future losses in this portfolio, which have been very low, could be higher than recent historical experience. Management believes that the aforementioned recovery may also negatively impact consumers’ repayment capacities. Additionally, a sizable portion of the Company’s consumer loan portfolio is secured by residential real estate, as discussed above, which is an area to be closely monitored by management in view of its stated concerns.

 
16


The allowance for loan losses established by MPS results from an estimation process that evaluates relevant characteristics of its credit portfolio(s). MPS also considers other internal and external environmental factors such as changes in operations or personnel and economic events that may affect the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses. Adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are recorded periodically based on the result of this estimation process. Due to the varied and unknown nature and structures of future credit programs, the exact methodology to determine the allowance for loan losses for each program will not be identical. Each program may have differing attributes including such factors as levels of risk, definitions of delinquency and loss, inclusion/exclusion of credit bureau criteria, roll rate migration dynamics, and other factors. Similarly, the additional capital required to offset the increased risk in subprime lending activities may vary by credit program. Each program will need to be evaluated separately and with potentially different methodologies. The increased charge-offs in fiscal 2010 for MPS credit resulted primarily from borrowers in a pre-season tax-related program that peaked in January 2010. Management pro-actively established a provision for loan losses for these loans during the tax pre-season offering period. The majority of the charge-offs for these pre-season tax loans were recorded against the allowance for loan losses in the third quarter of fiscal 2010. The charge-offs were in accordance with management’s expectations of the pre-season tax loan program. A reduction in charge offs in the MPS loan portfolio during fiscal 2011 is due to the discontinuance of iAdvance and tax-related loan programs in October 2010.

Management believes that, based on a detailed review of the loan portfolio, historic loan losses, current economic conditions, the size of the loan portfolio, and other factors, the current level of the allowance for loan losses at September 30, 2011 reflects an adequate allowance against probable losses from the loan portfolio. Although the Company maintains its allowance for loan losses at a level that it considers to be adequate, investors and others are cautioned that there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods. In addition, the Company's determination of the allowance for loan losses is subject to review by its bank regulator, the OCC, which can require the establishment of additional general or specific allowances.

Real estate properties acquired through foreclosure are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. If fair value at the date of foreclosure is lower than the balance of the related loan, the difference will be charged-off to the allowance for loan losses at the time of transfer. Valuations are periodically updated by management and, if the value declines, a specific provision for losses on such property is established by a charge to operations.

 
17


The following table sets forth an analysis of the Company’s allowance for loan losses. Balances related to the sale of a bank subsidiary in March 2008 treated as discontinued bank operations have been eliminated for all periods presented.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                               
Balance at Beginning of Period
  $ 5,234     $ 6,993     $ 5,732     $ 4,493     $ 6,391  
                                         
Charge Offs:
                                       
1-4 Family
    (229 )     (185 )     (28 )     (2 )     -  
Commercial & Multi Family
    (61 )     (6,979 )     (2,052 )     -       (1,762 )
Consumer
    (774 )     (12,139 )     (8,168 )     (5 )     (50 )
Commercial Business
    (43 )     (102 )     (7,685 )     (1,542 )     (3,803 )
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       (151 )     -       -  
Total Charge Offs
    (1,107 )     (19,405 )     (18,084 )     (1,549 )     (5,615 )
Recoveries:
                                       
1-4 Family
    -       1       465       7       -  
Commercial & Multi Family
    102       -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    419       1,242       90       12       3  
Commercial Business
    -       402       39       38       546  
Agricultural Operating
    -       210       38       16       -  
Total Recoveries
    521       1,855       632       73       549  
                                         
Net Charge Offs
    (586 )     (17,550 )     (17,452 )     (1,476 )     (5,066 )
Provision Charged to Expense
    278       15,791       18,713       2,715       3,168  
Balance at End of Period
  $ 4,926     $ 5,234     $ 6,993     $ 5,732     $ 4,493  
                                         
Ratio of Net Charge Offs During the Period to
                                       
Average Loans Outstanding During the Period
    0.17 %     4.36 %     4.12 %     0.36 %     1.43 %
                                         
Ratio of Net Charge Offs During the Period to
                                       
Non-Performing Assets at Year End
    3.69 %     180.98 %     118.70 %     19.64 %     194.03 %

For more information on the Provision for Loan Losses, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 
18


The distribution of the Company’s allowance for losses on loans at the dates indicated is summarized as follows:

   
At September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
Amount
   
Percent of Loans in Each Category of Total Loans
   
Amount
   
Percent of Loans in Each Category of Total Loans
   
Amount
   
Percent of Loans in Each Category of Total Loans
   
Amount
   
Percent of Loans in Each Category of Total Loans
   
Amount
   
Percent of Loans in Each Category of Total Loans
 
               
(Dollars in Thousands)
                   
                                                             
One-to-Four Family Real Estate
  $ 165       10.68 %   $ 50       11.00 %   $ 59       12.21 %   $ 98       12.96 %   $ 111       12.59 %
Commercial & Multi Family Real Estate
    3,901       60.87 %     3,053       55.06 %     4,231       58.33 %     3,236       51.24 %     1,246       47.13 %
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       6.36 %     111       6.97 %     111       6.70 %     94       6.91 %     70       4.60 %
Consumer
    16       10.77 %     738       12.93 %     243       9.03 %     207       11.36 %     153       10.20 %
Agricultural Operating
    67       6.64 %     125       8.74 %     569       7.00 %     1,645       7.18 %     178       9.19 %
Commercial Business
    36       4.68 %     131       5.30 %     792       6.73 %     148       10.35 %     2,404       16.29 %
Unallocated
    741       -       1,026       -       988       -       304       -       331       -  
Total
  $ 4,926       100.00 %   $ 5,234       100.00 %   $ 6,993       100.00 %   $ 5,732       100.00 %   $ 4,493       100.00 %

Investment Activities

General. The investment policy of the Company generally is to invest funds among various categories of investments and maturities based upon the Company’s need for liquidity, to achieve the proper balance between its desire to minimize risk and maximize yield, to provide collateral for borrowings, and to fulfill the Company’s asset/liability management policies. The Company’s investment and mortgage-backed securities portfolios are managed in accordance with a written investment policy adopted by the Board of Directors, which is implemented by members of the Company’s Investment Committee. As a result, the Company closely monitors balances in these accounts, and maintains a portfolio of highly liquid assets to fund potential deposit outflows. To date, the Company has not experienced any significant outflows related to MPS over the past six years, though no assurance can be given that this will continue to be the case.

As of September 30, 2011, the Company’s entire investment and mortgage-backed securities portfolios were classified as available for sale. For additional information regarding the Company’s investment and mortgage-backed securities portfolios, see Notes 1 and 3 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

As of September 30, 2011, investment and mortgage-backed securities with fair values of approximately $172.4 million were pledged as collateral for the Bank’s Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines (“FHLB”) advances and reverse repurchase agreements. For additional information regarding the Company’s collateralization of borrowings, see Notes 8 and 9 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statement,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “ Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Investment Securities. It is the Company’s general policy to purchase investment securities which are U.S. Government securities and federal agency obligations, state and local government obligations, commercial paper, corporate debt securities and overnight federal funds.

 
19


The following table sets forth the carrying value of the Company’s investment security portfolio, excluding mortgage-backed securities and other equity securities, at the dates indicated.

   
At September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Investment Securities
                 
Trust Preferred & Corporate Securities (1)
  $ 22,112     $ 17,551     $ 15,201  
Municipal Bonds
    6,218       3,916       2,365  
Subtotal
    28,330       21,467       17,566  
                         
FHLB Stock
    4,737       5,283       7,050  
                         
Total Investment Securities and FHLB Stock
  $ 33,067     $ 26,750     $ 24,616  
                         
Other Interest-Earning Assets:
                       
Interest bearing deposits in other financial institutions and
                       
Federal Funds Sold (2)
  $ 271,621     $ 80,811     $ 1,198  
___________
 
(1)
Within the trust preferred securities presented above, there are no securities from individual issuers that exceed 10% of the Company’s total equity. The name and the aggregate market value of securities of each individual issuer as of September 30, 2011 are as follows: Key Corp Capital I, $3.3 million; Bank Boston Capital Trust IV, $3.0 million; BankAmerica Capital III, $3.1 million; PNC Capital Trust, $3.6 million; Huntington Capital Trust II, $3.4 million.

 
(2)
The Company at times maintains balances in excess of insured limits at various financial institutions including the FHLB, the FRB and private institutions. At September 30, 2011, the Company had no interest bearing deposits held at the FHLB and $271.6 million in interest bearing deposits held at the FRB, respectively. At September 30, 2011, the Company had no federal funds sold at any private institution.

The composition and maturities of the Company’s investment securities portfolio, excluding equity securities, FHLB stock and mortgage-backed securities, are indicated in the following table.

   
September 30, 2011
 
   
1 Year or Less
   
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
   
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
   
After 10 Years
   
Total Investment Securities
 
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Amortized Cost
   
Fair Value
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                     
Trust Preferred & Corporate Securities
  $ -     $ 5,713     $ -     $ 16,399     $ 30,582     $ 22,112  
Municipal Bonds
    458       1,324       2,311       2,125       5,937       6,218  
Total Investment Securities
  $ 458     $ 7,037     $ 2,311     $ 18,524     $ 36,519     $ 28,330  
                                                 
Weighted Average Yield (1)
    6.09 %     3.46 %     3.94 %     1.56 %     1.97 %     2.30 %
_____________
(1)
Yields on tax-exempt obligations have not been computed on a tax-equivalent basis.

 
20


Mortgage-Backed Securities. The Company’s mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consists primarily of securities issued under government-sponsored agency programs, including those of Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. The Company historically has held Collateralized Mortgage Obligations (“CMOs”), as well as a limited amount of privately issued mortgage pass-through certificates. The Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac certificates are modified pass-through mortgage-backed securities that represent undivided interests in underlying pools of fixed-rate, or certain types of adjustable-rate, predominantly single-family and, to a lesser extent, multi-family residential mortgages issued by these government-sponsored entities. Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac generally provide the certificate holder a guarantee of timely payments of interest, whether or not collected. Ginnie Mae’s guarantee to the holder is timely payments of principal and interest, backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. Privately issued mortgage pass-through certificates generally provide no guarantee as to timely payment of interest or principal, and reliance is placed on the creditworthiness of the issuer, which the Company monitors on a regular basis.

At September 30, 2011, the Company had mortgage-backed securities with an amortized cost of $520.2 million, representing 85% of the total portfolio, which had fixed rates of interest and $52.0 million, representing 8.4% of the total portfolio, which had adjustable rates of interest.

Mortgage-backed securities generally increase the quality of the Company’s assets by virtue of the insurance or guarantees that back them, are more liquid than individual mortgage loans and may be used to collateralize borrowings or other obligations of the Company. At September 30, 2011, $302.1 million or 51% of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities were pledged to secure various obligations of the Company.

While mortgage-backed securities carry a reduced credit risk as compared to whole loans, such securities remain subject to the risk that a fluctuating interest rate environment, along with other factors such as the geographic distribution of the underlying mortgage loans, may alter the prepayment rate of such mortgage loans and so affect both the prepayment speed, and value, of such securities. The prepayment risk associated with mortgage-backed securities is monitored periodically, and prepayment rate assumptions adjusted as appropriate to update the Company’s mortgage-backed securities accounting and asset/liability reports.

The following table sets forth the carrying value of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities at the dates indicated.

   
At September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
CMO
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
Freddie Mac
    20,558       13,590       53,353  
Fannie Mae
    257,612       41,015       118,805  
Ginnie Mae
    312,748       430,780       175,114  
Privately Issued Mortgages Pass-Through Certificates
    -       -       -  
Total
  $ 590,918     $ 485,385     $ 347,272  

 
21


The following table sets forth the contractual maturities of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities at September 30, 2011. Not considered in the preparation of the table below is the effect of prepayments, periodic principal repayments and the adjustable-rate nature of these instruments.

   
September 30, 2011
 
   
1 Year or Less
   
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
   
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
   
After 10 Years
   
Total Investment Securities
 
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Carrying Value
   
Amortized Cost
   
Fair Value
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                     
Freddie Mac
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ 20,558     $ 19,930     $ 20,558  
Fannie Mae
    -       -       77,201       180,411       251,834       257,612  
Ginnie Mae
    -               15,007       297,741       300,703       312,748  
Total Investment Securities
  $ -     $ -     $ 92,208     $ 498,710     $ 572,467     $ 590,918  
                                                 
Weighted Average Yield
    0.00 %     0.00 %     2.56 %     3.52 %     3.36 %     3.37 %

At September 30, 2011, the contractual maturity of 84.4% of all of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities was in excess of ten years. The actual maturity of a mortgage-backed security is typically less than its stated maturity due to scheduled principal payments and prepayments of the underlying mortgages. Prepayments that are different than anticipated will affect the yield to maturity. The yield is based upon the interest income and the amortization of any premium or discount related to the mortgage-backed security. In accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“GAAP”), premiums and discounts are amortized over the estimated lives of the loans, which decrease and increase interest income, respectively. The prepayment assumptions used to determine the amortization period for premiums and discounts can significantly affect the yield of the mortgage-backed security, and these assumptions are reviewed periodically to reflect actual prepayments. Although prepayments of underlying mortgages depend on many factors, including the type of mortgages, the coupon rate, the age of mortgages, the geographical location of the underlying real estate collateralizing the mortgages and general levels of market interest rates, the difference between the interest rates on the underlying mortgages and the prevailing mortgage interest rates generally is the most significant determinant of the rate of prepayments. During periods of falling mortgage interest rates, if the coupon rate of the underlying mortgages exceeds the prevailing market interest rates offered for mortgage loans, refinancing generally increases and accelerates the prepayment of the underlying mortgages and the related security. Under such circumstances, the Company may be subject to reinvestment risk because, to the extent that the Company’s mortgage-backed securities amortize or prepay faster than anticipated, the Company may not be able to reinvest the proceeds of such repayments and prepayments at a comparable rate.

Management has implemented a process to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary. This process involves evaluation of the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, cash flow projections, and the Company's intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost which, in some cases, may extend to maturity. To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized.

For all securities that are considered temporarily impaired, the Company does not intend to sell these securities and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost, which may occur at maturity. The Company believes that it will collect all principal and interest due on all investments that have amortized cost in excess of fair value that are considered only temporarily impaired.

In fiscal 2011, there were no other-than-temporary impairments recorded. In fiscal 2010, the other-than-temporary impairments recorded against the trust preferred securities were $350,000. No other-than-temporary impairments were recorded against earnings during fiscal 2009.

 
22


Sources of Funds

General. The Company’s sources of funds are deposits, borrowings, amortization and repayment of loan principal, interest earned on or maturation of investment securities and short-term investments, mortgage-backed securities, and funds provided from operations.

Borrowings, including FHLB advances, repurchase agreements and FRB Discount Window, may be used at times to compensate for seasonal reductions in deposits or deposit inflows at less than projected levels, may be used on a longer-term basis to support expanded lending activities, and may also be used to match the funding of a corresponding asset.

Deposits. The Company offers a variety of deposit accounts having a wide range of interest rates and terms. The Company’s deposits consist of statement savings accounts, money market savings accounts, NOW and regular checking accounts, deposits related to prepaid cards that are primarily categorized as checking accounts, and certificate accounts currently ranging in terms from fourteen days to 60 months. The Retail Bank solicits deposits from its primary market area and relies primarily on competitive pricing policies, advertising and high-quality customer service to attract and retain these deposits.

The flow of deposits is influenced significantly by general economic conditions, changes in money market and prevailing interest rates, and competition.

The variety of deposit accounts offered by the Company has allowed it to be competitive in obtaining funds and to respond with flexibility to changes in consumer demand. The Company endeavors to manage the pricing of its deposits in keeping with its asset/liability management and profitability objectives. Based on its experience, the Company believes that its savings, money market accounts, NOW and regular checking accounts are relatively stable sources of deposits. However, the ability of the Company to attract and maintain certificates of deposit and the rates paid on these deposits has been and will continue to be significantly affected by market conditions and potentially by the restrictions imposed under the supervisory directives.

At September 30, 2011, $925.2 million of the Company’s deposit portfolio was attributable to MPS. The majority of these deposits represent un-spent funds on prepaid debit cards and other stored value products. $925.1 million are included with non-interest-bearing checking accounts and $0.1 million are included with money market accounts on the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Financial Condition. Generally, these deposits do not pay interest. MPS originates debit card programs through outside sales agents and other financial institutions. As such, these deposits carry a somewhat higher degree of concentration risk than traditional consumer products. If a major client or card program were to leave the Bank, deposit outflows could be more significant than if the bank were to lose a more traditional customer, although it is considered unlikely that all deposits related to a program would leave the Bank without significant advance notification. MPS has not experienced any significant outflows thus far related to card programs over the six years prior to the imposition of the supervisory directive implemented during the first quarter of fiscal 2011, and, although the potential for migration is higher now due to restrictions on the Bank, the Company’s low cost and no cost deposits have grown, as demonstrated below. See “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.” The Company takes this additional risk into account when planning its investment and liquidity strategies, but no assurance can be given that our efforts will remain successful. See “Risk Factors” which is included in Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The increase in deposits arising from MPS has also allowed the Bank to reduce its reliance on higher costing certificates of deposits and public funds.

 
23


The following table sets forth the deposit flows at the Company during the periods indicated.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Opening Balance
  $ 897,454     $ 653,747     $ 499,804  
Deposits
    124,923,489       112,086,496       91,862,382  
Withdrawals
    (124,681,473 )     (111,845,663 )     (91,713,207 )
Sale of Deposits
    -       -       -  
Interest Credited
    2,150       2,874       4,768  
                         
Ending Balance
  $ 1,141,620     $ 897,454     $ 653,747  
                         
Net Increase
  $ 244,166     $ 243,707     $ 153,943  
                         
Percent Increase
    27.21 %     37.28 %     30.80 %

The following table sets forth the dollar amount of savings deposits in the various types of deposit programs offered by the Company for the periods indicated.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Amount
   
Percent of Total
   
Amount
   
Percent of Total
   
Amount
   
Percent of Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                     
Transactions and Savings Deposits:
                                   
                                     
Non-Interest Bearing Demand Accounts
  $ 945,956       82.86 %   $ 675,163       75.23 %   $ 442,158       67.63 %
Interest Bearing Demand Accounts
    31,249       2.74       29,976       3.34       15,602       2.39  
Savings Accounts
    11,136       0.97       10,821       1.20       10,001       1.53  
Money Market Accounts
    36,717       3.22       35,422       3.95       39,823       6.09  
                                                 
Total Non-Certificate
    1,025,058       89.79       751,382       83.72       507,584       77.64  
                                                 
Certificates:
                                               
                                                 
Variable
    284       0.03       380       0.04       524       0.08  
0.00 - 1.99%
    74,145       6.49       82,716       9.22       36,523       5.59  
2.00 - 3.99%
    35,189       3.08       51,852       5.78       78,288       11.98  
4.00 - 5.99%
    6,944       0.61       11,114       1.24       30,806       4.71  
6.00 - 7.99%
    -       -       10       0.00       22       0.00  
                                                 
Total Certificates
    116,562       10.21       146,072       16.28       146,163       22.36  
Total Deposits
  $ 1,141,620       100.00 %   $ 897,454       100.00 %   $ 653,747       100.00 %

 
24


The following table shows rate and maturity information for the Company’s certificates of deposit as of September 30, 2011.

   
Variable
      0.00- 1.99 %     2.00- 3.99 %     4.00- 5.99 %     6.00- 7.99 %  
Total
   
Percent of Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Certificate accounts maturing in quarter ending:
                                                 
                                                   
December 31, 2011
  $ 47     $ 30,300     $ 2,214     $ 497     $ -     $ 33,058       28.4  
March 31, 2012
    106       5,703       1,394       1,223       -       8,426       7.2  
June 30, 2012
    48       12,201       1,373       1,018       -       14,640       12.6  
September 30, 2012
    40       4,564       811       819       -       6,234       5.3  
December 31, 2012
    22       12,453       16,636       2,803       -       31,914       27.4  
March 31, 2013
    21       1,257       1,368       151       -       2,797       2.4  
June 30, 2013
    -       3,177       1,922       20       -       5,119       4.4  
September 30, 2013
    -       1,375       517       -       -       1,892       1.6  
December 31, 2013
    -       1,244       889       413       -       2,546       2.2  
March 31, 2014
    -       285       637       -       -       922       0.8  
June 30, 2014
    -       297       614       -       -       911       0.8  
September 30, 2014
    -       170       1,057       -       -       1,227       1.0  
Thereafter
    -       1,119       5,757       -       -       6,876       5.9  
                                                         
Total
  $ 284     $ 74,145     $ 35,189     $ 6,944     $ -     $ 116,562       100.0 %
                                                         
Percent of total
    0.2 %     63.6 %     30.2 %     6.0 %     0.0 %     100.0 %        

The following table indicates the amount of the Company’s certificates of deposit and other deposits by time remaining until maturity as of September 30, 2011.

   
Maturity
 
   
3 Months or Less
   
After 3 to 6 Months
   
After 6 to 12 Months
   
After 12 Months
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                               
Certificates of deposit less than $100,000
  $ 20,998     $ 6,717     $ 13,607     $ 37,279     $ 78,601  
                                         
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more
    12,060       1,709       7,267       16,925     $ 37,961  
                                         
Total certificates of deposit
  $ 33,058     $ 8,426     $ 20,874     $ 54,204     $ 116,562  

At September 30, 2011, there were $0.6 million in deposits from governmental and other public entities included in certificates of deposit.

Borrowings. Although deposits are the Company’s primary source of funds, the Company’s policy has been to utilize borrowings when they are a less costly source of funds, can be invested at a positive interest rate spread, or when the Company desires additional capacity to fund loan demand.

The Company’s borrowings historically have consisted primarily of advances from the FHLB upon the security of a blanket collateral agreement of a percentage of unencumbered loans and the pledge of specific investment securities. Such advances can be made pursuant to several different credit programs, each of which has its own interest rate and range of maturities. At September 30, 2011, the Bank had $11.0 million of advances from the FHLB and the ability to borrow up to an approximate additional $214.7 million. At September 30, 2011, there were no advances that had terms to maturity of one year or less. The remaining $11.0 million had maturities ranging up to 8 years.

 
25


On July 16, 2001, the Company issued all of the 10,000 authorized shares of Company Obligated Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Securities of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I (preferred securities of subsidiary trust) holding solely subordinated debt securities. Distributions are paid semi-annually. Cumulative cash distributions are calculated at a variable rate of the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 3.75%, not to exceed 12.5%. The Company may, at one or more times, defer interest payments on the capital securities for up to 10 consecutive semi-annual periods, but not beyond July 25, 2031. At the end of any deferral period, all accumulated and unpaid distributions will be paid. The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has a semi-annual option to shorten the maturity date to a date not earlier than July 25, 2007. The option has not been exercised as of the date of this filing. The redemption price is $1,000 per capital security plus any accrued and unpaid distributions to the date of redemption plus, if redeemed prior to July 25, 2011, a redemption premium as defined in the Indenture Agreement. Holders of the capital securities have no voting rights, are unsecured and rank junior in priority of payment to all of the Company’s indebtedness and senior to the Company’s common stock. The trust preferred securities have been includable in the Company’s capital calculations since they were issued.

From time to time, the Company has offered retail repurchase agreements to its customers. These agreements typically range from 14 days to five years in term, and typically have been offered in minimum amounts of $100,000. The proceeds of these transactions are used to meet cash flow needs of the Company. At September 30, 2011, the Company had $8.1 million of retail repurchase agreements outstanding.

Historically, the Company has entered into wholesale repurchase agreements through nationally recognized broker-dealer firms. These agreements are accounted for as borrowings by the Company and are secured by certain of the Company’s investment and mortgage-backed securities. The broker-dealer takes possession of the securities during the period that the reverse repurchase agreement is outstanding. The terms of the agreements have usually ranged from 7 days to six months, but on occasion longer term agreements have been entered into. At September 30, 2011, the Company had no wholesale repurchase agreements outstanding.

At September 30, 2011, the Company did not have a line of credit with First Tennessee Bank, NA. See Note 8 to the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements," which is included in Part II, Item 8 "Financial Statements and Supplementary Data" of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further detail of the Company's borrowings.

The following table sets forth the maximum month-end balance and average balance of FHLB advances, retail and reverse repurchase agreements, Subordinated Debentures and under the FRB’s Temporary Term Auction Facility (“TAF”) Program borrowings for the periods indicated.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Maximum Balance:
                 
FHLB advances
  $ 117,000     $ 148,000     $ 100,950  
Repurchase agreements
    11,787       11,880       24,351  
Subordinated debentures
    10,310       10,310       10,310  
FRB TAF Borrowings
    -       50,000       25,000  
Overnight Fed Funds Purchased
    20,000       10,000       -  
                         
Average Balance:
                       
FHLB advances
  $ 37,947     $ 75,067     $ 46,844  
Repurchase agreements
    6,018       7,479       13,299  
Subordinated debentures
    10,310       10,310       10,310  
FRB TAF Borrowings
    -       6,113       2,123  
Overnight Fed Funds Purchased
    1,507       1,689       -  

 
26


The following table sets forth certain information as to the Company’s FHLB advances and other borrowings at the dates indicated.

   
September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
FHLB advances
  $ 11,000     $ 22,000     $ 74,800  
Repurchase agreements
    8,055       8,904       6,686  
Subordinated debentures
    10,310       10,310       10,310  
FRB TAF Borrowings
    -       -       25,000  
                         
Total borrowings
  $ 29,365     $ 41,214     $ 116,796  
                         
Weighted average interest rate of FHLB advances
    6.00 %     5.10 %     3.26 %
                         
Weighted average interest rate of repurchase agreements
    0.50 %     0.50 %     0.49 %
                         
Weighted average interest rate of subordinated debentures
    4.31 %     4.21 %     4.38 %
                         
Weighted average interest rate of FRB TAF Borrowings
    0.00 %     0.25 %     0.25 %

Subsidiary Activities

The subsidiaries of the Company are the Bank and First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I. The Bank has one service corporation subsidiary, First Services Financial Limited (“First Services”). At September 30, 2011, the net book value of the Bank’s investment in First Services was approximately $115,000. The Bank organized First Services in 1983. First Services currently has no active operations. The Company had a subsidiary in prior fiscal periods, Meta Trust, which was sold to a third party on September 30, 2010. The impact to the financial results of the Company was nominal.

Meta Payment Systems® Division

Meta Financial, through the MPS division of its bank subsidiary, is focused on the electronic payments industry and offers a complement of prepaid cards, consumer credit products and other payment industry related products and services that are marketed to consumers through financial institutions and other commercial entities. The products and services offered by MPS are generally designed to facilitate the processing and settlement of authorized electronic transactions involving the movement of funds. MPS offers specific product solutions in the following areas: (i) prepaid cards, (ii) consumer credit products, and (iii) ATM sponsorship. MPS’ products and services generally target banks, card processors and third parties who market and distribute the cards.

Each segment of MPS’ business is discussed generally below. With respect to the segments, there can be a significant amount of cross-selling and cross-utilization of personnel and resources (e.g., a client asks MPS to develop products for both prepaid and consumer credit needs). As described elsewhere herein, the Bank is subject to restrictions set forth in the supervisory directives issued by the OTS. For further discussion see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

Prepaid Cards. Prepaid cards take the form of credit card-sized plastics embedded with a magnetic stripe which encodes relevant card data (which may or may not include information about the user and/or purchaser of such card). When the holder of such a card attempts a permitted transaction, necessary information, including the authorization for such transaction, is shared between the “point of use” or “point of sale” and authorization systems maintaining the account of record.

 
27


The funds associated with such cards are typically held in pooled accounts at the Bank representing the aggregate value of all cards issued in connection with particular products or programs, further described below. The cards may work in a closed loop (e.g., the card will only work at one particular merchant and will not work anywhere else), a semi-closed loop (e.g., the card will only work at a specific set of merchants such as a shopping mall), or open loop which function as a Visa, MasterCard, or Discover branded debit card that will work wherever such cards are accepted for payment. Most of MPS’ prepaid cards are open-loop.

This segment of MPS’ business can generally be divided into three categories: reloadable cards, non-reloadable cards, and benefit/insurance cards. These programs are typically offered via a third party relationship. We are under restriction, by order of OTS, not to enter into new third party relationships or amend same absent prior approval. For further information, see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.” Government benefits are another growing application for prepaid cards; however, MPS has not focused on this category to date.

Reloadable Cards. The most common reloadable prepaid card programs are payroll cards, whereby an employee’s payroll is loaded to the card by their employer utilizing direct deposit. General Purpose Reloadable (GPR) cards, whereby cards are usually distributed by retailers and can be reloaded an indefinite number of times at participating retail load networks. Other examples of reloadable cards are travel cards which are used to replace travelers checks and can be reloaded a predetermined number of times as well as tax cards where a taxpayer’s refund, refund anticipation loan, or preseason tax loan proceeds are placed on the card. Reloadable cards are generally open loop cards that consumers can use to obtain cash at ATMs or purchase goods and services wherever such cards are accepted for payment.

Non-Reloadable Cards. Non-reloadable prepaid cards are sometimes referred to as disposable and may only be used until the relevant funds initially loaded to the card have been exhausted. These include gift cards, rebate cards, and promotional or incentive cards. These cards may be closed loop or open loop but are generally not available to obtain cash. Under certain conditions, these cards may be anonymous, whereby no customer relationship is created and the identity of the cardholder is unknown. Except for gift cards, many non-reloadable card programs are funded by a corporation as a marketing expense rather than from consumer funds.

Benefit/Insurance Cards. Benefit/insurance cards are traditionally used by employers and large commercial companies (such as property insurers) to distribute benefits to persons entitled to such funds. Possible uses of benefit cards could be the distribution of money for qualified expenses related to an employer sponsored flexible spending account program (FSA) or the distribution of insurance claim proceeds to insureds who have made a payable claim against an existing insurance policy. These cards are generally open loop or semi-closed loop as in the case of an FSA card that can only be used for qualified medical expenses.

Consumer Credit Products. In its belief that credit programs can help meet legitimate credit needs for prime and sub-prime borrowers, and afford the Company an opportunity to diversify the loan portfolio and minimize earnings exposure due to economic downturns, the Company has offered certain credit programs that were designed to accomplish these objectives. One such program – iAdvance – was eliminated at the direction of the OTS effective October 13, 2010. Further, as was the case in fiscal 2011, we will not offer tax-related programs, such as pre-season or refund anticipation loans or refund transfer services in fiscal 2012. For further information, see “Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”
 
MPS has strived to offer consumers innovative payment products, including credit products. Most credit products have fallen into one of two general categories: (1) sponsorship lending and (2) portfolio lending. In a sponsorship lending model, MPS typically originates loans and sells (without recourse) the resulting receivables to third party investors equipped to take the associated credit risk. MPS’s sponsorship lending programs are governed by the Policy for Sponsorship Lending which has been approved by the Board of Directors. A Portfolio Credit Policy which has been approved by the Board of Directors governs portfolio credit initiatives undertaken by MPS, whereby the Company retains some or all receivables and relies on the borrower as the underlying source of repayment. Several portfolio lending programs also have a contractual provision that has indemnified MPS and the Bank for credit losses that meet or exceed predetermined levels. Such a program carries additional risks not commonly found in sponsorship programs, specifically funding and credit risk. Therefore, MPS has strived to employ policies, procedures, and information systems that are commensurate with the added risk and exposure. Due to supervisory directives issued by our regulator, an MPS lending program - iAdvance – was eliminated effective October 13, 2010. In addition, our third party relationship programs have been limited to third party relationships in existence at the time the directives were issued, absent prior approval to engage in new relationships. For additional discussion, see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”
 
 
28


ATM Sponsorship. MPS sponsors financial institutions into various networks to enable them to issue network-branded debit cards and accept cards issued by other financial institutions at their ATM terminals. The division also sponsors ATM independent sales organizations (“ISOs”) into various networks and provides associated sponsorships of encryption support organizations and third party processors in support of the financial institutions and the ATM ISO sponsorships. Sponsorship consists of the review and oversight of entities participating in debit and credit networks. In certain instances, MPS also has certain leasehold interests in certain ATMs which require bank ownership and registration for compliance with applicable state law.

While the Company believes that it has adopted policies and procedures to manage and monitor the risks attendant to this line of business, and while the executives who manage the Company’s program have years of experience, no guarantee can be made that the Company will not experience losses in this division.

The same restrictions applicable to third-party relationships as described above also apply to our ATM Sponsorship business; See “Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

Regulation

The Company is regulated as a savings and loan holding company by the Federal Reserve. As a savings and loan holding company, the Company is required to file reports with, and otherwise comply with, the rules and regulations of the Federal Reserve and of the SEC under federal securities laws. The Bank is a federally chartered thrift institution that is subject to broad federal regulation and oversight extending to all of its operations by the OCC, its primary federal regulator, and by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) as deposit insurer. The Bank is also a member of the FHLB. See “Risk Factors” which is included in Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The legislative and regulatory enactments described below have had a material impact upon the operations of the Company and the Bank.

Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 ("the Dodd-Frank Act"). In response to the current national and international economic recession and to strengthen supervision of financial institutions and systemically important nonbank financial institutions, Congress and the U.S. government have taken a variety of actions, including the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act on July 21, 2010. The Dodd-Frank Act represents the most comprehensive change to banking laws since the Great Depression of the 1930s and mandates changes in several key areas: regulation and compliance (both with respect to financial institutions and systemically important nonbank financial companies), securities regulation, executive compensation, regulation of derivatives, corporate governance, transactions with affiliates, deposit insurance assessments and consumer protection. Importantly for the Bank, the Dodd-Frank Act also abolished the OTS on July 21, 2011, and transferred rulemaking authority and regulatory oversight to the OCC with respect to federal savings banks, such as the Bank, and to the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System with respect to savings and loan holding companies, such as the Company. While the changes in the law required by the Dodd-Frank Act will most significantly have a major impact on large institutions, even relatively small institutions such as ours will be affected.

Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Bank will be subject to regulations promulgated by a new consumer protection bureau housed within the Federal Reserve, known as the Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection (the "Bureau" or “BCFP”). The Bureau will consolidate rules and orders with respect to consumer financial products and services and will have substantial power to define the rights of consumers and responsibilities of lending institutions, such as the Bank. The Bureau will not, however, examine or supervise the Bank for compliance with such regulations; rather, based on its size, enforcement authority will remain with the Bank's primary federal regulator although the Bank may be required to submit reports or other materials to the Bureau upon its request. The Bureau began to exercise its authority on July 21, 2011 with respect to insured depository institutions like the Bank.

The Dodd-Frank Act included provisions which restrict interchange fees to those which are “reasonable and proportionate” for certain debit card issuers and limits the ability of networks and issuers to restrict debit card transaction routing (known as the “Durbin Amendment”). The Federal Reserve issued final rules implementing the Durbin Amendment on June 29, 2011. In the final rule, interchange fees for debit card transactions are capped at $0.21 plus five basis points to be eligible for a “safe harbor” such that the fee is conclusively reasonable and proportionate. An interim final rule also permits an additional $0.01 per transaction “fraud prevention adjustment” to the interchange fee if certain standards designed by the Federal Reserve are implemented. With respect to network exclusivity and merchant routing restrictions, it is now required that all debit cards participate in at least two unaffiliated networks so that the transactions initiated using those debit cards will have at least two independent routing channels. Notably, the interchange fee restrictions in the Durbin Amendment do not apply to the Bank because debit card issuers with total worldwide assets of less than $10 billion are exempt.

 
29


The Dodd-Frank Act also included a provision that supplements the Federal Trade Commission Act's prohibitions against practices that are unfair or deceptive by also prohibiting practices that are "abusive." This term has not yet been defined by implementing regulations but, once it is defined, the Bank will be required to evaluate all of its consumer financial products and services to ensure they are in compliance with this provision.

In addition, and among other legislative changes that we and the Bank will need to assess, the Dodd-Frank Act requires us to: (1) be subject to a new assessment model from the FDIC based upon assets, not deposits (as described herein); (2) be subject to enhanced executive compensation and corporate governance requirements; and (3) evaluate our capital compliance at the holding company level due to our issuance of trust preferred securities.

The extent to which the new legislation and existing and planned governmental initiatives thereunder will succeed in ameliorating tight credit conditions or otherwise result in an improvement in the national economy is uncertain. In addition, because some of the component parts of the Dodd-Frank Act will be subject to intensive agency rulemaking and subsequent public comment over the next several months, it is difficult to predict the ultimate effect of the Dodd-Frank Act on us or the Bank at this time. It is likely, however, that our operational expenses will increase as a result of new compliance requirements.

S.A.F.E. Act Requirements. On July 28, 2010, the OTS issued final rules requiring residential mortgage loan originators who are employees of federal savings banks to meet the registration requirements of the Secure and Fair Enforcement for Mortgage Licensing Act of 2008 (the "S.A.F.E. Act"). The S.A.F.E. Act requires residential mortgage loan originators who are employees of regulated financial institutions to be registered with the Nationwide Mortgage Licensing System and Registry, a database created by the Conference of State Bank Supervisors and the American Association of Residential Mortgage Regulators to support the licensing of mortgage loan originators by the states (the "Registry"). Employees of regulated financial institutions are generally prohibited from originating residential mortgage loans unless they are registered. Federal registrants were permitted to register January 1, 2011.

Incentive Compensation Regulation. The OTS issued on June 21, 2010 final guidance to ensure that incentive compensation arrangements at federal savings banks take into account risk and are consistent with safe and sound banking practices. The guidance was designed to ensure that incentive compensation arrangements appropriately tie rewards to longer-term performance and do not undermine the safety and soundness of the entity or create undue risks to the financial system. As a result of this guidance, the Company and the Bank will incorporate the risks related to incentive compensation into their broader risk-management framework.

USA Patriot Act of 2001. In October 2001, the USA Patriot Act of 2001 (the “Patriot Act”) was enacted in response to the terrorist attacks in New York, Pennsylvania and Washington, D.C. which occurred on September 11, 2001. The Patriot Act is intended to strengthen U.S. law enforcement’s and the intelligence communities’ abilities to work cohesively to combat terrorism on a variety of fronts. The potential impact of the Patriot Act on financial institutions of all kinds is significant and wide-ranging. The Patriot Act contains sweeping anti-money laundering and financial transparency laws and imposes various regulations, including standards for verifying client identification at account opening, and rules to promote cooperation among financial institutions, regulators and law enforcement entities in identifying parties that may be involved in terrorism or money laundering. Among other provisions, the Patriot Act requires financial institutions to have anti-money laundering programs in place and requires banking regulators to consider a holding company’s effectiveness in combating money laundering when ruling on certain merger or acquisition applications.

Credit Card Regulation. The Credit Card Accountability Responsibility and Disclosure Act was signed into law on May 22, 2009 (the “Credit Card Act”). The Credit Card Act bans retroactive rate increases, requires that bills be due no less than 21 days from the time of mailing, requires that credit card contracts be accessible on the Internet, and allows consumers to opt-in if they choose to use a card issuer’s over-limit protection. While certain open-end credit programs of the Bank will be impacted by the Credit Card Act, the operational and financial impact to the Bank will be immaterial. The Bank does not anticipate that any of its open-end line of credit programs will be discontinued or extensively modified as a result of the Credit Card Act. Two of the Bank’s credit card programs will have significant changes to the terms and conditions as a result of the Credit Card Act. However, the account portfolio for these programs is relatively small, so any financial impact to the Bank due to any modifications to these programs will be minimal.

 
30


Gift card provisions in the Credit Card Act took effect on August 22, 2010. These provisions impose new restrictions on the use of expiration dates and fees on gift cards, including both open-loop and closed-loop cards. Certain provisions can also apply to general purpose reloadable and promotional cards (i.e., reloadable cards that are not marketed or labeled as gift cards, cards not marketed to the general public and cards that are loyalty or award cards are not subject to the fee and expiration restrictions). If a card is subject to the Credit Card Act's fee restrictions, then (1) fees cannot be imposed within a year after the card was issued or within a year after the cardholder's last use, (2) only one fee is permitted in any month, and (3) certain disclosures related to the fees and the timing of their imposition must be clearly and conspicuously disclosed. If a card is subject to the Credit Card Act's expiration provisions, then the card must give consumers a reasonable opportunity to purchase the card with at least five years remaining until the card expiration date and the funds loaded onto such card must not expire before the later of five years after the date on which the card was issued or the card expiration date (if any). As a result of these changes, we expect there will be a reduction in the Company’s revenue of approximately $2.0 million in fiscal 2011.

The Homeowners Affordability and Stability Plan (“HASP”). Announced in February 2009, the HASP is a $75.0 billion dollar federal program providing for loan modifications targeted at borrowers who are at risk of foreclosure because their incomes are not sufficient to meet their mortgage payments. It is anticipated that this program will have minimal impact on the Company.

Home Affordable Refinance Program (“HARP”). Announced in November 2011, the HARP is available for refinances of existing and qualified Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac loans only. The goal of the refinance effort, as announced by the President of the United States, is "to provide access to low-cost refinancing for responsible homeowners suffering from falling home prices." The expectation is that refinancing a qualified loan will put responsible borrowers in a better position by reducing their monthly principal and interest payments or moving them from a more risky loan structure (such as interest-only or short-term ARM) to a more stable product. It is anticipated that this program will have minimal impact on the Company.

Privacy. The Bank is required by statute and regulation to disclose their privacy policies to its consumers and, on an annual basis, to its customers. Pursuant to such privacy notices, the Bank’s customers may opt out of the sharing of their nonpublic personal information with non-affiliated third parties. The Bank is also required to appropriately safeguard its customers’ personal information.

Preemption. On July 21, 2011, the preemption provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act became effective, requiring that federal savings associations be subject to the same preemption standards as national banks, with respect to the application of state consumer laws to the inter-state activities of federally chartered depository institutions. Under the preemption standards established under the Dodd-Frank Act for both national banks and federal savings associations, preemption of a state consumer financial law is permissible only if: (1) application of the state law would have a discriminatory effect on national banks or federal thrifts as compared to state banks; (2) the state law is preempted under a judicial standard that requires a state consumer financial law to prevent or significantly interfere with the exercise of the national bank's or federal thrift's powers before it can be preempted, with such preemption determination being made by the OCC (by regulation or order) or by a court, in either case on a "case-by-case" basis; or (3) the state law is preempted by another provision of federal law other than Title X of the Dodd-Frank Act. Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act specifies that such preemption standards only apply to national banks and federal thrifts themselves, and not their non-depository institution subsidiaries or affiliates. Specifically, operating subsidiaries of national banks and federal thrifts that are not themselves chartered as a national bank or federal thrift may no longer benefit from federal preemption of state consumer financial laws, which shall apply to such subsidiaries (or affiliates) to the same extent that they apply to any person, corporation or entity subject to such state laws.

 
31


Prohibition on Unfair, Deceptive and Abusive Acts and Practices. July 21, 2011 was the designated transfer date under the Dodd-Frank Act for the formal transfer of rulemaking functions under the federal consumer financial laws from each of the various federal banking agencies to a new governmental entity, the BCFP, which is charged with the mission of protecting consumer interests. The BCFP is responsible for administering and carrying out the purposes and objectives of the federal consumer financial laws and to prevent evasions thereof, with respect to all financial institutions that offer financial products and services to consumers. The BCFP is also authorized to prescribe rules applicable to any covered person or service provider identifying and prohibiting acts or practices that are unfair, deceptive or abusive in connection with any transaction with a consumer for a consumer financial product or service, or the offering of a consumer financial product or service. With its broad rulemaking powers, the new BCFP has the potential to reshape the consumer financial laws through rulemaking, which may directly impact the business operations of financial institutions offering consumer financial products or services including the Bank.

Other Regulation. The Bank is also subject to a variety of other regulations with respect to their business operations including, but not limited to, the Truth in Lending Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, and the Fair Credit Reporting Act. As discussed below, any change in the regulations affecting the Bank’s operations is not predicable and could affect the Bank’s operations and profitability.

Bank Supervision & Regulation
 
The Bank is a federally chartered thrift institution that is subject to broad federal regulation and oversight extending to all of its operations by its primary federal regulator, the OCC, and by its deposit insurer, the FDIC. Such regulation covers all aspects of the banking business, including lending practices, safeguarding deposits, capital structure, transactions with affiliates and conduct and qualifications of personnel.

The Bank is also a member of the FHLB System and is subject to certain limited regulation by the FRB.

Meta Financial currently has two wholly-owned subsidiaries: the Bank, a federally chartered thrift institution; and First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I, a statutory business trust organized under the Delaware Business Trust Act.

Regulatory authorities have been granted extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities which are intended to strengthen the financial condition of the banking industry, including the imposition of restrictions on the operation of an institution, the classification of assets by the institution, and the adequacy of an institution’s allowance for loan losses. Typically, these actions are undertaken due to violations of laws or regulations or conduct of operations in an unsafe or unsound manner.

Any change in the nature of such regulation and oversight, whether by the OCC, the FDIC, the Federal Reserve or legislatively by Congress, could have a material impact on Meta Financial or the Bank and their respective operations. The discussion herein of the regulatory and supervisory structure within which the Bank operates is general and does not purport to be exhaustive or a complete description of the laws and regulations involved in the Bank’s operations. The discussion is qualified in its entirety by the actual laws and regulations.

Federal Regulation of the Bank. As the new primary federal regulator for federal savings associations as of July 21, 2011, the OCC has extensive authority over the operations of federal savings associations, such as the Bank. This regulation and supervision establishes a comprehensive framework for activities in which a federal savings association can engage and is intended primarily for the protection of the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”) and depositors. The regulatory structure also gives the regulatory authorities extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities and examination policies, including policies with respect to the classification of assets and the establishment of adequate loan loss reserves for regulatory purposes.

 
32


Given the extensive transfer of former OTS authority to multiple agencies, section 316 of the Dodd-Frank Act requires the OCC to identify and publish in the Federal Register separate lists of the current OTS regulations that the OCC will continue to enforce for federal savings associations after the transfer date. In carrying out this mandate, and in connection with its assumption of responsibility for the ongoing examination, supervision, and regulation of federal savings associations, the OCC published a final rule on July 21, 2011 that republishes those OTS regulations that the OCC has the authority to promulgate and enforce as of the July 21, 2011 transfer date, with nomenclature and other technical amendments to reflect OCC supervision of federal savings associations. The OCC's regulations supersede the OTS regulations for purposes of OCC supervision and regulation of federal savings associations.

In promulgating the final rule, the OCC noted that the final rule is part of the OCC's review of its regulations and those of the OTS to determine what changes are needed for the transition to OCC supervision of federal savings associations, and that in future phases of the OCC's regulatory review, the OCC will consider more comprehensive substantive amendments, as necessary, to these regulations. For example, the OCC notes that it may propose to repeal or combine provisions in cases where OCC and former OTS rules are substantively identical or substantially overlap. In addition, the OCC may propose to repeal or modify OCC or former OTS rules where differences in regulatory approach are not required by statute or warranted by features unique to either charter. The OCC expects to publish these amendments in one or more notices of proposed rulemaking. This substantive review also will provide an opportunity for the OCC to ask for comments suggesting revisions to the rules for both national banks and federal savings associations that would remove provisions that are "outmoded, ineffective, insufficient, or excessively burdensome," consistent with the goals outlined in an executive order issued by the President of the United States. Accordingly, it is possible that additional OCC rulemaking could require significant revisions to the regulations under which the Bank operates and is supervised. Any change in such laws and regulations or interpretations thereof, whether by the OCC, the FDIC or through legislation, could have a material adverse impact on the Bank and its operations and on the Company and its stockholders.

Business Activities

The activities of federal savings associations are generally governed by federal laws and regulations. These laws and regulations delineate the nature and extent of the activities in which federal savings associations may engage. In particular, many types of lending authority for federal savings associations are limited to a specified percentage of the institution's capital or assets.

Loan and Investment Powers

The Bank derives its lending and investment powers from the Home Owners’ Loan Act (the “HOLA”) and the OCC's implementing regulations thereunder. Under these laws and regulations, the Bank may invest in mortgage loans secured by residential and commercial real estate, commercial and consumer loans, certain types of debt securities and certain other assets. The Bank may also establish service corporations that may engage in activities not otherwise permissible for the Bank, including certain real estate equity investments and securities and insurance brokerage activities. These investment powers are subject to various limitations, including (i) a prohibition against the acquisition of any corporate debt security that is not rated in one of the four highest rating categories; (ii) a limit of 400% of an association's capital on the aggregate amount of loans secured by non-residential real estate property; (iii) a limit of 20% of an association's assets on the aggregate amount of commercial and agricultural loans and leases with the amount of commercial loans in excess of 10% of assets being limited to small business loans; (iv) a limit of 35% of an association's assets on the aggregate amount of secured consumer loans and acquisitions of certain debt securities, with amounts in excess of 30% of assets being limited to loans made directly to the original obligor and where no third- party finder or referral fees were paid; (v) a limit of 5% of assets on non-conforming loans (loans in excess of the specific limitations of the HOLA); and (vi) a limit of the greater of 5% of assets or an association's capital on certain construction loans made for the purpose of financing what is or is expected to become residential property. In addition, the HOLA and the OCC regulations provide that a federal savings association may invest up to 10% of its assets in tangible personal property for leasing purposes.

The Bank’s general permissible lending limit to one borrower is equal to the greater of $500,000 or 15% of unimpaired capital and surplus (except for loans fully secured by certain readily marketable collateral, in which case this limit is increased to 25% of unimpaired capital and surplus). At September 30, 2011, the Bank’s lending limit under these restrictions was $12.9 million. The Bank is in compliance with this lending limit.

 
33


OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.

During 2010, the OTS issued Supervisory Directives to the Bank based on the OTS’ assessment of the Bank’s third-party relationship risk, enterprise risk management, and rapid growth (in the MPS division) and had also advised the Bank that the OTS had determined that the Bank engaged in unfair or deceptive acts or practices in violation of Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act and the OTS Advertising Regulation in connection with the Bank’s operation of the iAdvance line of credit program. On July 15, 2011, the Company and the Bank each stipulated and consented to a Cease and Desist Order (together, the "Orders" or the “Consent Orders”) issued by the OTS. Under the Orders, the OTS and the Bank agreed upon a Remuneration Plan to provide reimbursement to iAdvance Line of Credit borrowers affected by the Bank’s failure to implement a recurring use plan. The Remuneration Plan provides for an aggregate amount of $4.8 million to be paid iAdvance customers. The Bank also stipulated and consented to an Order of Assessment of a Civil Money Penalty (the "Assessment") providing for the Bank's payment of $400,000. The Orders and the Assessment became effective on July 15, 2011. Both sums were paid in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011. Under the terms of the Orders and the Assessment, the OTS acknowledged that the Company and the Bank neither admitted nor denied the OTS findings in the Orders and the Assessment or that grounds existed to initiate a proceeding.

The Orders require the Company and the Bank to submit to the OTS (or its successor) various management and compliance plans and programs to address the matters initially identified in the Supervisory Directives as well as plans for enhancing Company and Bank capital and require non-objection by OTS (or its successor) for Company cash dividends, distributions, share repurchases, payments of interest or principal on debt and incurrence of debt. Under the terms of the Order, the Bank agrees that it will cease and desist from (1) violations of certain laws and regulations and (2) unsafe or unsound practices that resulted in it operating without adequate: (a) internal controls, management information systems and internal audit reviews of its third party sponsorship arrangements; and (b) certain information technology policies and procedures. The limitations related to MPS following the issuance of the Supervisory Directives remain in place. Such limitations include receiving the prior written approval of the Regional Director of the OTS (or its successor) before the Bank may (1) enter into any new third party relationship agreement concerning any credit product, deposit product (including prepaid cards), or automatic teller machine or materially amend any such existing agreement (except for amendments to achieve compliance with applicable laws, regulations, or regulatory guidance); (2) originate, directly or through any third party, tax refund anticipation loans; (3) offer a tax refund transfer processing service directly or through any third party; or (4) offer or originate iAdvance lines of credit to new customers or permit draws on existing iAdvance lines of credit, either directly or through any third party.

The Orders further require the Company and the Bank to submit to the OTS (or its successor) various management and compliance plans and programs to address the matters initially identified in the Supervisory Directives as well as plans for enhancing Company and Bank capital. Although there can be no assurance that such actions will continue in the future, by separate letter agreement, the OTS took no objection to the Company’s request to prepay its scheduled July 2011 trust preferred security payment; similarly, the Federal Reserve has approved the Company’s declaration of a dividend payable on January 1, 2012 to stockholders of record on December 12, 2011. Both the Company and the Bank remain well-capitalized under federal banking guidelines after the reimbursement and the Assessment.

Since the issuance of the Supervisory Directives and the Consent Orders, the Company and the Bank have been cooperating with the OTS and the OCC to correct those aspects of its operations that were addressed in the Orders, and management of the Company and the Bank believe they have already made substantial progress. The Company and the Bank have completed many of the items in the Orders and expect to complete all of the required actions in the Orders by their respective deadline dates.

Compliance with the Orders will be subject to the review and supervision of the OCC with respect the Bank and the Federal Reserve Board with respect to the Company. There can be no assurance that the Company or the Bank can fully comply with the requirements of the Orders or receive non-objection to the Company's future payment of dividends and interest, or any other activity for which approval or non-objection is required.

 
34


On July 21, 2011, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the OTS was integrated into the OCC and the functions of the OTS related to thrift holding companies were transferred to the Federal Reserve Board. The OCC is now responsible for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of the Bank. The Dodd-Frank Act maintains the existence of the federal savings association charter and the HOLA, the primary statute governing the federal savings banks. The Federal Reserve Board is now responsible for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of the Company.

Insurance of Accounts and Regulation by the FDIC. The Bank is a member of the DIF, which is administered by the FDIC. Deposits are insured up to applicable limits by the FDIC and such insurance is backed by the full faith and credit of the United States Government. As insurer, the FDIC imposes deposit insurance premiums and is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require reporting by FDIC-insured institutions. It also may prohibit any FDIC-insured institution from engaging in any activity the FDIC determines by regulation or order to pose a serious risk to the DIF. The FDIC also has authority to initiate enforcement actions against any FDIC-insured institution after giving its primary federal regulator the opportunity to take such action, and may terminate the deposit insurance if it determines that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or is in an unsafe or unsound condition.

The FDIC imposes an assessment against all depository institutions for deposit insurance. Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, with respect to deposit insurance premiums, the new assessment base calculation will be average consolidated total assets less average tangible equity (defined as Tier 1 capital). At September 30, 2011, the Bank’s risk category assignment required a payment of $0.04 per $100 of its total assessment base of approximately $1.1 billion. The FDIC's board has the flexibility to adopt actual rates that are higher or lower than the total base assessment rates adopted without notice and comment if certain restrictions are met.

The FDIC announced on November 12, 2009, that insured depository institutions were required to prepay three years of deposit insurance premiums on December 30, 2009. Under the rule, the prepaid amount was based on an estimate of the institution’s assessment rate in effect on September 30, 2009, its third quarter 2009 assessment base, and an estimated rate of increase in that assessment base. MetaBank was assessed $4.1 million. As of April 1, 2011, the final rule on FDIC Deposit Insurance became effective.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, a permanent increase in deposit insurance was authorized to $250,000 (insurance coverage had previously been temporarily raised to that level until December 13, 2013). The coverage limit is per depositor, per insured depository institution for each account ownership category.

The Dodd-Frank Act also set a new minimum DIF reserve ratio at 1.35% of estimated insured deposits. The FDIC is required to attain this ratio by September 30, 2020.

Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (“FDIA”), the FDIC may terminate deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC or the OCC. Management of the Bank does not know of any practice, condition or violation that might lead to termination of deposit insurance. A significant increase in DIF insurance premiums would have an adverse effect on the operating expenses and results of operations of the Bank.

DIF-insured institutions pay a Financing Corporation (“FICO”) assessment in order to fund the interest on bonds issued to resolve thrift failures in the 1980s. At September 30, 2011, the FICO assessment was equal to 1.04 basis points for each $100 in domestic deposits. These assessments will continue until the bonds mature in 2019.

Assessments. The Dodd-Frank Act transferred authority to collect assessments for federal savings associations from the OTS to the OCC. This authority was effective as of the transfer date, July 21, 2011. The Dodd-Frank Act also provides that, in establishing the amount of an assessment, the Comptroller of the Currency may consider the nature and scope of the activities of the entity, the amount and type of assets it holds, the financial and managerial condition of the entity, and any other factor that is appropriate. Prior to the transfer date, the OCC and the OTS assessed banks and savings associations, respectively, using different methodologies, although the agencies' methodologies generally resulted in similar levels of assessments. Under the OTS assessment system, assessments were due each year on January 31 and July 31, and were calculated based on an institution's asset size, condition, and complexity. The Bank's OTS assessment (standard assessment) for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2011, was $233,000. The OCC final rule effective on July 21, 2011 amended the assessment rules applicable to federal savings associations by using the same methodologies, rates, fees, and payment due dates that apply currently to national banks. The OTS assessment system and regulation is no longer in effect and will be repealed at a later date. As a result, the assessment for savings associations occurred in September 2011.

 
35


Under the OCC's assessment system, some savings associations will pay marginally more assessments than in the past, while others will pay lower assessments. However, during the first two assessment cycles after the transfer date, the OCC will base savings association assessments on either the OCC's assessment regulation (as amended to include federal savings associations) or the former OTS assessment structure, whichever yields the lower assessment for that savings association. Beginning with assessments charged in September 2012, all national banks and federal savings associations will be assessed using the OCC's assessment structure. The OCC intends to implement this phase-in through an amended Notice of Fees.

Regulatory Capital Requirements. Federally insured financial institutions, such as the Bank, are required to maintain a minimum level of regulatory capital. These capital requirements mandate that an institution maintain at least the following ratios: (1) a core (or Tier 1) capital to adjusted total assets ratio of 4% (which can be reduced to 3% for highly rated institutions); (2) a Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets ratio of 4%; and (3) a risk-based capital to risk-weighted assets ratio of 8%. Core (Tier 1) capital is defined as common stockholders’ equity (including retained earnings), certain noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus and minority investments in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, less intangibles other than certain mortgage servicing rights and credit card relationships. Supplementary capital is currently defined to include cumulative preferred stock, long-term perpetual preferred stock, mandatory convertible securities, subordinated debt and intermediate preferred stock, the allowance for loan and lease losses limited to a maximum of 1.25% of risk-weighted assets and up to 45% of unrealized gains on available-for-sale equity securities with readily determinable fair market values. Overall, the amount of supplementary capital included as part of total capital cannot exceed 100% of core capital.

Generally, in meeting the tangible, leverage and risk-based capital standards, federal savings associations must deduct investments in and loans to subsidiaries engaged in activities as principal that are not permissible for a national bank. If a subsidiary’s activities are permitted to a national bank, that subsidiary’s assets are generally consolidated with those of the parent’s on a line-for-line basis.

Capital requirements in excess of the standards set forth above may be imposed on individual institutions on a case-by-case basis upon a determination that the association’s capital level is or may become inadequate in light of the particular circumstances. The OCC and the FDIC are generally permitted to take enforcement action against a savings bank that fails to meet its capital requirements. Such action may include restrictions on operations and banking activities, the imposition of a capital directive, a cease-and-desist order, civil money penalties, or more stringent measures such as the appointment of a conservator or receiver or a forced merger with another institution.

As of September 30, 2011, the Bank exceeded all of its regulatory capital requirements with core, tangible and risk-based capital ratios of 6.38%, 6.38% and 20.12% respectively, and was designated as “well-capitalized” under federal guidelines. See Note 14 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Prompt Corrective Action. Federal banking regulators are authorized and, under certain circumstances, required to take certain actions against banks that fail to meet their capital requirements. Effective December 19, 1992, the federal banking agencies were given additional enforcement authority with respect to undercapitalized depository institutions. Under the regulations, an institution is deemed to be (a) “well capitalized” if it has total risk-based capital of 10.0% or more, has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or more, has a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio of 5.0% or more and is not subject to any order or final capital directive to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure; (b) “adequately capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or more, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.0% or more and a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio of 4.0% or more (3.0% under certain circumstances) and does not meet the definition of well capitalized; (c) “undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 8.0%, a tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 4.0% or a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio that is less than 4.0% (3.0% under certain circumstances); (d) “significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 3.0% or a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio that is less than 3.0%; and (e) “critically undercapitalized” if it has a ratio of tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%. In certain situations, a federal banking agency may reclassify a well capitalized institution as adequately capitalized and may require an adequately capitalized or undercapitalized institution to comply with supervisory actions as if the institution were in the next lower category.

 
36


The federal banking agencies are generally required to take action to restrict the activities of an “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” or “critically undercapitalized” bank. Any such bank must submit a capital restoration plan that is guaranteed by the parent holding company. Until such plan is approved, it may not increase its assets, acquire another institution, establish a branch or engage in any new activities, and generally may not make capital distributions. The banking regulators are authorized to impose additional restrictions, discussed below, that are applicable to significantly undercapitalized institutions.

Adequately capitalized banks cannot normally pay dividends or make any capital contributions that would leave it undercapitalized; they cannot pay a management fee to a controlling person if, after paying the fee, it would be undercapitalized; and they cannot accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit unless the bank has applied for and been granted a waiver by the FDIC. Under a new interest rate restriction rule that became effective in January 2010, the FDIC has defined the “national rate” for all interest-bearing deposits held by less-than-well capitalized institutions as “a simple average of rates paid by all insured depository institutions and branches for which data are available” and has stated that its presumption is that this national rate is the prevailing rate in any market. As such, less-than-well capitalized institutions generally may not pay an interest rate in excess of the national rate plus 75 basis points.

Undercapitalized banks may not accept, renew or rollover brokered deposits, and are subject to restrictions on the soliciting of deposits over prevailing rates. In addition, undercapitalized banks are subject to certain regulatory restrictions. These restrictions include, among others, that such a bank generally may not make any capital distributions, must submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to the FDIC, may not increase its average total assets during a calendar quarter in excess of its average total assets during the preceding calendar quarter unless any increase in total assets is consistent with a capital restoration plan approved by the FDIC and the bank’s ratio of equity to total assets increases during the calendar quarter at a rate sufficient to enable the Bank to become adequately capitalized within a reasonable time. In addition such banks may not acquire a business, establish or acquire a branch office or engage in a new line of business without regulatory approval. In addition, as part of a capital restoration plan, the Company must generally guarantee that the bank will return to adequately capitalized status and provide appropriate assurances of performance of that guarantee. If a capital restoration plan is not approved, or if the bank fails to implement the plan in any material respect, the bank would be treated as if it were “significantly undercapitalized,” which would result in the imposition of a number of additional requirements and restrictions. It should also be noted all FDIC-insured institutions are assigned an assessment risk. In general, weaker banks (those with a higher assessment risk) are subject to higher assessments than stronger banks. An adverse change in category can lead to materially higher expenses for insured institutions. Finally, bank regulatory agencies have the ability to seek to impose higher than normal capital requirements known as individual minimum capital requirements (“IMCR”) for institutions with higher risk profiles. If the Bank’s capital status – now well-capitalized – changes as a result of future operations or regulatory order, the company’s financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected. See “— OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

Any institution that fails to comply with its capital plan or is “significantly undercapitalized” (i.e., Tier 1 risk-based or core capital ratios of less than 3% or a risk-based capital ratio of less than 6%) must be made subject to one or more of additional specified actions and operating restrictions mandated by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”). These actions and restrictions include requiring the issuance of additional voting securities; limitations on asset growth; mandated asset reduction; changes in senior management; divestiture, merger or acquisition of the association; restrictions on executive compensation; and any other action the OTS deems appropriate. An institution that becomes “critically undercapitalized” is subject to further mandatory restrictions on its activities in addition to those applicable to significantly undercapitalized associations. In addition, the appropriate banking regulator must appoint a receiver (or conservator with the FDIC’s concurrence) for an institution, with certain limited exceptions, within 90 days after it becomes critically undercapitalized. Any undercapitalized institution is also subject to other possible enforcement actions, including the appointment of a receiver or conservator. The appropriate regulator is also generally authorized to reclassify an institution into a lower capital category and impose restrictions applicable to such category if the institution is engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or is in an unsafe or unsound condition.

 
37


The imposition of any of these measures on the Bank may have a substantial adverse effect on it and on the Company’s operations and profitability. Meta Financial stockholders do not have preemptive rights and, therefore, if Meta Financial is directed by the OCC or the FDIC to issue additional shares of Common Stock, such issuance may result in the dilution in stockholders’ percentage of ownership of Meta Financial.

Institutions in Troubled Condition. Certain events, including entering into a formal written agreement with a bank’s regulator that requires action to improve the bank’s financial condition, or simply being informed by the regulator that the bank is in troubled condition, will automatically result in limitations on so-called “golden parachute” agreements pursuant to Section 18(K) of the FDIA. In addition, organizations that are in troubled condition must give 30 days written notice before appointing a Director or Senior Executive Officer, pursuant to Section 32 of the FDIA. The Bank and the Company are subject to these requirements.

Branching by Federal Savings Associations. Subject to certain limitations, the HOLA and the OCC regulations permit federally chartered savings associations to establish branches in any state of the United States. The authority to establish such branches is available (i) if the law of the state in which the branch is located, or is to be located, would permit establishment of the branch if the savings association were a state savings association chartered by such state or (ii) if the association qualifies as a "domestic building and loan association" under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, which imposes qualification requirements similar to those for a "qualified thrift lender" under the HOLA. See "—Qualified Thrift Lender Test." The branching authority under the HOLA and the OCC regulations preempts any state law purporting to regulate branching by federal savings associations.

Standards for Safety and Soundness. The federal banking agencies have adopted the Interagency Guidelines Establishing Standards for Safety and Soundness. The guidelines establish certain safety and soundness standards for all depository institutions. The operational and managerial standards in the guidelines relate to the following: (1) internal controls and information systems; (2) internal audit systems; (3) loan documentation; (4) credit underwriting; (5) interest rate exposure; (6) asset growth; (7) compensation, fees and benefits; (8) asset quality; and (9) earnings. Again, rather than providing specific rules, the guidelines set forth basic compliance considerations and guidance with respect to a depository institution. Failure to meet the standards in the guidelines, however, could result in a request by the OCC to the Bank to provide a written compliance plan to demonstrate its efforts to come into compliance with such guidelines.

Limitations on Dividends and Other Capital Distributions. Federal regulations govern the permissibility of capital distributions by a federal savings association. Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings associations that are part of a savings and loan holding company structure must now file a notice of a declaration of a dividend with the Federal Reserve. In the case of cash dividends, OCC regulations require that federal savings associations that are subsidiaries of a stock savings and loan holding company must file an informational copy of that notice with the OCC at the same time it is filed with the Federal Reserve. OCC regulations further set forth the circumstances under which a federal savings association is required to submit an application or notice before it may make a capital distribution.

A federal savings association proposing to make a capital distribution is required to submit an application to the OCC if: (1) the association does not qualify for expedited treatment pursuant to criteria set forth in OCC regulations; (2) the total amount of all of the association's capital distributions (including the proposed capital distribution) for the applicable calendar year exceeds the association's net income for that year to date plus the association's retained net income for the preceding two years; (3) the association would not be at least adequately capitalized following the distribution; or (4) the proposed capital distribution would violate a prohibition contained in any applicable statute, regulation, or agreement between the association and the OCC or the Company's and Bank's former regulator, the OTS, or violate a condition imposed on the association in an application or notice approved by the OCC or the OTS.

 
38


A federal savings association proposing to make a capital distribution is required to submit a prior notice to the OCC if: (1) the association would not be well capitalized following the distribution; (2) the proposed capital distribution would reduce the amount of or retire any part of the association's common or preferred stock or retire any part of debt instruments such as notes or debentures included in the association's capital (other than regular payments required under a debt instrument); or (3) the association is a subsidiary of a savings and loan holding company and is not required to file a notice regarding the proposed distribution with the Federal Reserve, in which case only an informational copy of the notice filed with the Federal Reserve needs to be simultaneously provided to the OCC.

Each of the Federal Reserve and OCC have primary reviewing responsibility for the applications or notices required to be submitted to them by savings associations relating to a proposed distribution. The Federal Reserve may disapprove of a notice, and the OCC may disapprove of a notice or deny an application, if:

 
the savings association would be undercapitalized following the distribution;

 
the proposed distribution raises safety and soundness concerns; or

 
the proposed distribution violates a prohibition contained in any statute, regulation, enforcement action or agreement between the savings association (or its holding company, in the case of the Federal Reserve) and the entity's primary federal regulator, or a condition imposed on the savings association (or its holding company, in the case of the Federal Reserve) in an application or notice approved by the entity's primary federal regulator.

Under current regulations, the Bank is not permitted to pay dividends on its stock if its regulatory capital would fall below the amount required for the liquidation account established to provide a limited priority claim to the assets of the Bank to qualifying depositors at March 31, 1992, who continue to maintain deposits at the Bank after its conversion from a federal mutual savings and loan association to a federal stock savings bank pursuant to its Plan of Conversion adopted August 21, 1991.

During the fiscal year ended September 30, 2011, the Bank paid no cash dividends to the Company, as the Company utilized existing cash holdings for payment of dividends to the Company's stockholders and other holding company expenses.

Qualified Thrift Lender Test. All savings associations, including the Bank, are required to meet a qualified thrift lender (“QTL”) test to avoid certain restrictions on their operations. This test requires a savings association to have at least 65% of its portfolio assets (as defined by regulation) in qualified thrift investments (primarily residential mortgages and related investments, including certain mortgage-backed securities) on a monthly average for nine out of every 12 months on a rolling basis or meet the requirements for a domestic building and loan association under the Internal Revenue Code. Under either test, the required assets primarily consist of residential housing related to loans and investments. At September 30, 2011, the Bank met the test and always has since its effectiveness.

Any savings association that fails to meet the QTL test must convert to a national bank charter, unless it qualifies as a QTL within one year and thereafter remains a QTL, or limits its new investments and activities to those permissible for both a savings association and a national bank. In addition, the association is subject to national bank limits for payment of dividends and branching authority. If such association has not requalified or converted to a national bank within three years after the failure, it must divest all investments and cease all activities not permissible for a national bank.

Community Reinvestment Act. Under the Community Reinvestment Act (the "CRA"), the Bank is evaluated periodically by its primary federal banking regulator to determine if it is meeting its continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with its safe and sound operation to help meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low and moderate income neighborhoods. In the Bank's most recent CRA examination, notwithstanding that the Bank's record was consistent with an overall rating of "Satisfactory," the Bank received a "Needs to Improve" rating due to the criticized credit practices associated with the iAdvance product, which the Bank is no longer offering. The CRA requires the OCC, our new regulator, to take such rating into account in considering an application for any of the following: (i) the establishment of a domestic branch; (ii) the relocation of its main office or of a branch; (iii) the merger or consolidation with or acquisition of assets or assumption of liabilities of an insured depository institution; or (iv) the conversion of the Bank to a national charter. If the Bank submitted any of the above-listed applications, the OCC may consider the Bank's overall "Needs to Improve" rating negatively.

 
39


Interstate Banking and Branching. The FRB may approve an application of an adequately capitalized and adequately managed bank holding company to acquire control of, or acquire all or substantially all of the assets of, a bank located in a state other than such holding company's home state, without regard to whether the transaction is prohibited by the laws of any state. In general, the FRB may not approve the acquisition of a bank that has not been in existence for the minimum time period (not exceeding five years) specified by the statutory law of the host state or if the applicant (and its depository institution affiliates) controls or would control more than 10% of the insured deposits in the United States or 30% or more of the deposits in the target bank’s home state or in any state in which the target bank maintains a branch. Iowa has adopted a five year minimum existence requirement.

The federal banking agencies are also generally authorized to approve interstate merger transactions without regard to whether such transaction is prohibited by the law of any state. Interstate acquisitions of branches or the establishment of a new branch is permitted only if the law of the state in which the branch is located permits such acquisitions. Interstate mergers and branch acquisitions are also subject to the nationwide and statewide insured deposit concentration amounts described above. Iowa permits interstate branching only by merger.

Transactions with Affiliates. The Bank must comply with Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act relative to transactions with “affiliates,” generally defined to mean any company that controls or is under common control with the institution (as such, Meta Financial is an affiliate of the Bank for these purposes). Transactions between an institution or its subsidiaries and its affiliates are required to be on terms as favorable to the Bank as terms prevailing at the time for transactions with nonaffiliates. In addition, certain of these transactions, such as loans to an affiliate, are restricted to a percentage of the institutions’ capital (e.g., the aggregate amount of covered transactions with any individual affiliate is limited to 10% of the capital and surplus of the institution; the aggregate amount of covered transactions with all affiliates is limited to 20% of the institution’s capital and surplus). In addition, a savings and loan holding company may not lend to any affiliate engaged in activities not permissible for a savings and loan holding company or acquire the securities of most affiliates. The OCC has the discretion to treat subsidiaries of savings institutions as affiliates on a case-by-case basis.

On April 1, 2003, the Federal Reserve’s Regulation W, which comprehensively amends sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, became effective. The Federal Reserve Act and Regulation W are applicable to the Bank. The Regulation unifies and updates staff interpretations issued over the years, incorporates several new interpretive proposals (such as to clarify when transactions with an unrelated third party will be attributed to an affiliate) and addresses new issues arising as a result of the expanded scope of non-banking activities engaged in by banks and bank holding companies in recent years and authorized for financial holding companies under the Financial Services Modernization Act of 1999.

The Dodd-Frank Act also included specific changes to the law related to the definition of "covered transaction" in Sections 23A and 23B and limitations on asset purchases from insiders. With respect to the definition of "covered transaction," the Dodd-Frank Act now defines that term to include the acceptance of debt obligations issued by an affiliate as collateral for a bank's loan or extension of credit to another person or company. In addition, a "derivative transaction" with an affiliate is now deemed to be a "covered transaction" to the extent that such a transaction causes a bank or its subsidiary to have a credit exposure to the affiliate. A separate provision of the Dodd-Frank Act states that an insured depository institution may not "purchase an asset from, or sell an asset to" a bank insider (or their related interests) unless (1) the transaction is conducted on market terms between the parties, and (2) if the proposed transaction represents more than 10 percent of the capital stock and surplus of the insured institution, it has been approved in advance by a majority of the institution's non-interested directors.

Certain transactions with directors, officers or controlling persons are also subject to conflict of interest regulations. These conflict of interest regulations and other statutes also impose restrictions on loans to such persons and their related interests. Among other things, such loans must be made on terms substantially the same as for loans to unaffiliated individuals and must not create an abnormal risk of repayment or other unfavorable features for the Bank.

 
40


Federal Home Loan Bank System. The Bank is a member of the FHLB, one of 12 regional FHLBs that administers the home financing credit function of savings associations that is subject to supervision and regulation by the Federal Housing Finance Agency. All advances from the FHLB are required to be fully secured by sufficient collateral as determined by the FHLB. In addition, all long-term advances must be used for residential home financing.

As members of the FHLB System, the Bank is required to purchase and maintain activity-based capital stock in the FHLB in the amount of 4.45% to support outstanding advances and mortgage loans. At September 30, 2011, the Bank had in the aggregate $4.7 million in FHLB stock, which was in compliance with this requirement. For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2011, dividends paid by the FHLB to the Bank totaled $179,000.

Under federal law, the FHLBs are required to provide funds for the resolution of troubled savings associations and to contribute to low- and moderately priced housing programs through direct loans or interest subsidies on advances targeted for community investment and low- and moderate-income housing projects. These contributions have affected adversely the level of FHLB dividends paid and could continue to do so in the future. These contributions could also have an adverse effect on the value of FHLB stock in the future. A reduction in value of the Bank’s FHLB stock may result in a corresponding reduction in the Bank’s capital. In addition, the federal agency that regulates the FHLBs has required each FHLB to register its stock with the SEC, which will increase the costs of each FHLB and may have other effects that are not possible to predict at this time.

Federal Securities Law. The common stock of Meta Financial is registered with the SEC under the Exchange Act, as amended. Meta Financial is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading restrictions and other requirements under the Exchange Act.

Meta Financial’s stock held by persons who are affiliates (generally officers, directors and principal stockholders) of the Company may not be resold without registration unless sold in accordance with certain resale restrictions. If Meta Financial meets specified current public information requirements, each affiliate of the Company, subject to certain requirements, will be able to sell, in the public market, without registration, a limited number of shares in any three-month period.

Holding Company Supervision & Regulation

We are a unitary savings and loan holding company within the meaning of the HOLA. As such, we are required to register with and be subject to Federal Reserve examination and supervision as well as certain reporting requirements. In addition, the Federal Reserve has enforcement authority over us and any of our non-savings institution subsidiaries. Among other things, this authority permits the Federal Reserve to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to be a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of a subsidiary savings association.

As noted above, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve assumed responsibility for the primary supervision and regulation of all savings and loan holding companies, including the Company, on July 21, 2011. Given the extensive transfer of former OTS authority to multiple agencies, the Dodd-Frank Act requires the Federal Reserve to identify and publish in the Federal Register separate lists of the OTS regulations that the Federal Reserve will continue to enforce for savings and loan holding companies after the transfer date. In carrying out this mandate, and in connection with its assumption of responsibility for the ongoing examination, supervision, and regulation of savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve has published an interim final rule that provides for the corresponding transfer from the OTS to the Federal Reserve of the regulations necessary for the Federal Reserve to administer the statutes governing savings and loan holding companies.

 
41


Restrictions Applicable to All Savings and Loan Holding Companies.

Federal law prohibits a savings and loan holding company, including us, directly or indirectly, from acquiring:

• control (as defined under the HOLA) of another savings institution (or a holding company parent) without prior Federal Reserve approval;

• through merger, consolidation, or purchase of assets, another savings institution or a holding company thereof, or acquiring all or substantially all of the assets of such institution (or a holding company) without prior Federal Reserve approval; or

• control of any depository institution not insured by the FDIC (except through a merger with and into the holding company's savings institution subsidiary that is approved by the Federal Reserve).

A savings and loan holding company may not acquire as a separate subsidiary an FDIC-insured institution that has a principal office outside of the state where the principal office of its subsidiary institution is located, except:

• in the case of certain emergency acquisitions approved by the FDIC;

• if such holding company controls a savings institution subsidiary that operated a home or branch office in such additional state as of March 5, 1987; or

• if the laws of the state in which the savings institution to be acquired is located specifically authorize a savings institution chartered by that state to be acquired by a savings institution chartered by the state where the acquiring savings institution or savings and loan holding company is located, or by a holding company that controls such a state chartered association.

The HOLA also prohibits a savings and loan holding company (directly or indirectly, or through one or more subsidiaries) from acquiring or retaining, with certain exceptions, more than 5% of a non-subsidiary savings association, a non-subsidiary holding company, or a non-subsidiary company engaged in activities other than those permitted by the HOLA. In evaluating applications by holding companies to acquire savings associations, the Federal Reserve must consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the company and institution involved, the effect of the acquisition on the risk to the DIF, the convenience and needs of the community and competitive factors.

Failure to Meet QTL Test.

If a banking subsidiary of a savings and loan holding company fails to meet the QTL test, the holding company must register with the FRB as a bank holding company within one year of the savings institution’s failure to comply.

Activities Restrictions

Prior to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings and loan holding companies were generally permitted to engage in a wider array of activities than those permissible for their bank holding company counterparts and may have concentrations in real estate lending that are not typical for bank holding companies. Section 606 of the Dodd-Frank Act amended the HOLA by inserting a new requirement that conditions the ability of non-grandfathered savings and loan holding companies that are not exempt from the HOLA's restrictions on activities to engage in certain activities. Pursuant to this new requirement, a covered savings and loan holding company may engage in activities that are permissible only for a financial holding company under section 4(k) of the BHCA if the covered company meets all of the criteria to qualify as a financial holding company, and complies with all of the requirements applicable to a financial holding company as if the covered savings and loan holding company was a bank holding company. Moreover, going forward, savings and loan holding companies engaging in new activities permissible for bank holding companies will need to comply with notice and filing requirements of the Federal Reserve.

 
42


If the Federal Reserve believes that an activity of a savings and loan holding company or a nonbank subsidiary constitutes a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of a subsidiary savings association and is inconsistent with the principles of sound banking, the purposes of the HOLA or other applicable statutes, the Federal Reserve may require the savings and loan holding company to terminate the activity or divest control of the nonbanking subsidiary. This obligation is established in section 10(g)(5) of the HOLA and bank holding companies are subject to equivalent obligations under the BHCA and the Federal Reserve’s Regulation Y.

Source of Strength and Capital Requirements

The Dodd-Frank Act requires all companies, including savings and loan holding companies, that directly or indirectly control an insured depository institution to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary savings associations. Moreover, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings and loan holding companies are now subject to the same capital and activity requirements as those applicable to bank holding companies although there is a five-year phase-in period from the date of enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act to comply with the new capital requirements.

In addition, as discussed in the Federal Reserve's Notice of Intent issued on April 15, 2011, the Federal Reserve, together with the other federal banking agencies, is reviewing consolidated capital requirements for all depository institutions and their holding companies pursuant to section 171 of the Dodd-Frank Act and the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision's "Basel III: A global regulatory framework for more resilient banks and banking systems" report ("Basel III"). It is expected that the Basel III notice of proposed rulemaking also would address any proposed application of Basel III-based requirements to savings and loan holding companies. When the rule-making process is complete, it is anticipated that this definition will be changed to be more closely aligned to the definition of well-capitalized for bank holding companies.

Examination

In connection with its assumption of responsibility for the ongoing supervision and examination of savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve issued a supervisory letter on July 21, 2011 that described the supervisory approach the Federal Reserve will use during the first supervisory cycle and going forward generally for savings and loan holding companies. For purposes of the guidance, the first supervisory cycle is the period of time between July 21, 2011, and the close of the first required inspection. To help facilitate the transition of savings and loan holding companies to the supervisory jurisdiction of the Federal Reserve, the Federal Reserve noted in its letter that the first cycle of savings and loan holding company inspections will be instructive to both the Federal Reserve and savings and loan holding company management in terms of practical issues that arise in the supervision of a savings and loan holding company. In particular, examiners will be using the first supervisory cycle to inform savings and loan holding companies how their operations compare to the Federal Reserve's supervisory expectations, which is expected to allow for savings and loan holding company management to make operational changes in response to the Federal Reserve's supervisory expectations, if necessary. Also, the Federal Reserve plans to use the first inspections for the Federal Reserve supervisory staff to better understand a savings and loan holding company's operations and business model and how the Federal Reserve's holding company supervision framework can most effectively be implemented at these companies. Accordingly, the Federal Reserve's focus for inspection activities during the first supervisory cycle will be on gaining an understanding of the structure and operations of each savings and loan holding company.

After the first supervisory cycle and going forward, the Federal Reserve intends, to the greatest extent possible taking into account any unique characteristics of savings and loan holding companies and the requirements of the HOLA, to assess the condition, performance, and activities of savings and loan holding companies on a consolidated basis in a manner that is consistent with the Federal Reserve's established risk-based approach regarding bank holding company supervision. As with bank holding companies, the Federal Reserve's objective will be to ensure that a savings and loan holding company and its nondepository subsidiaries are effectively supervised and can serve as a source of strength for, and do not threaten the soundness of, its subsidiary depository institution(s).

 
43


In accordance with its goal to assess the condition, performance, and activities of savings and loan holding companies on a consolidated basis in a manner that is consistent with the Federal Reserve's established risk-based approach regarding bank holding company supervision, the Federal Reserve anticipates transitioning savings and loan holding companies to the Federal Reserve's "RFI/C(D)" rating system (commonly referred to as "RFI"). The Federal Reserve expects to issue a notice shortly outlining application of the RFI rating system to savings and loan holding companies and any modifications that the Federal Reserve believes are necessary to accommodate savings and loan holding companies. That notice will provide the public with an additional opportunity to comment and will provide for a transition period before Federal Reserve examiners will assign final RFI ratings.

Change of Control

The federal banking laws require that appropriate regulatory approvals must be obtained before an individual or company may take actions to "control" a bank or savings association. The definition of control found in the HOLA is similar to that found in the BHCA for bank holding companies. Both statutes apply a similar three-prong test for determining when a company controls a bank or savings association. Specifically, a company has control over either a bank or savings association if the company:

 
(1)
directly or indirectly or acting in concert with one or more persons, owns, controls, or has the power to vote 25% or more of the voting securities of a company;

 
(2)
controls in any manner the election of a majority of the directors (or any individual who performs similar functions in respect of any company, including a trustee under a trust) of the board; or

 
(3)
directly or indirectly exercises a controlling influence over the management or policies of the bank.

The Federal Reserve recently adopted an interim final rule that, among other things, implements the HOLA to govern the operations of savings and loan holding companies. The new rule, known as Regulation LL, includes a specific definition of "control" similar to the statutory definition, with certain additional provisions. Additionally, Regulation LL modifies the regulations previously used by the OTS for purposes of determining when a company or natural person acquires control of a savings association or savings and loan holding company under the HOLA or the Change in Bank Control Act ("CBCA"). In light of the similarity between the statutes governing bank holding companies and savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve proposes to use its established rules and processes with respect to control determinations under the HOLA and the CBCA to ensure consistency between equivalent statutes administered by the same agency.

The Federal Reserve stated in the interim final rule that it will review investments and relationships with savings and loan holding companies by companies using the current practices and policies applicable to bank holding companies to the extent possible. Overall, the indicia of control used by the Federal Reserve under the BHCA to determine whether a company has a controlling influence over the management or policies of a banking organization (which for Federal Reserve purposes, will now include savings associations and savings and loan holding companies) are similar to the control factors found in OTS regulations. However, the OTS rules weigh these factors somewhat differently and use a different review process designed to be more mechanical.

Among the differences highlighted by the Federal Reserve with respect to OTS procedures on determinations of control, the Federal Reserve noted that it does not limit its review of companies with the potential to have a controlling influence to the two largest stockholders. Specifically, the Federal Reserve reviews all investors based on all of the facts and circumstances to determine if a controlling influence is present.

Moreover, unlike the OTS control rules, the Federal Reserve does not have a separate application process for rebutting control under the BHCA and Regulation LL does not include such a process. Under the former OTS rules, investors that triggered a control factor under the rules could submit an application to the OTS requesting a determination that they have successfully rebutted control under the HOLA. This separate application process is not available under Regulation LL. Given that Federal Reserve practice is to consider potential control relationships for all investors in connection with applications submitted under the BHCA, the Federal Reserve will review potential control relationships for all investors in connection with applications submitted to the Federal Reserve under Section 10(e) or 10(o) of the HOLA. As with OTS practice, the Federal Reserve often obtains a series of commitments from investors seeking non-control determinations.

 
44


Federal and State Taxation

Federal Taxation. Meta Financial and its subsidiaries file consolidated federal income tax returns on a fiscal year basis using the accrual method of accounting. In addition to the regular income tax, corporations, including savings banks such as the Bank, generally are subject to a minimum tax. An alternative minimum tax is imposed at a minimum tax rate of 20% on alternative minimum taxable income, which is the sum of a corporation’s regular taxable income (with certain adjustments) and tax preference items, less any available exemption. The alternative minimum tax is imposed to the extent it exceeds the corporation’s regular income tax and net operating losses can offset no more than 90% of alternative minimum taxable income.

To the extent earnings appropriated to a savings bank’s bad debt reserves and deducted for federal income tax purposes exceed the allowable amount of such reserves computed under the experience method and to the extent of the bank’s supplemental reserves for losses on loans (“Excess”), such Excess may not, without adverse tax consequences, be utilized for the payment of cash dividends or other distributions to a stockholder (including distributions on redemption, dissolution or liquidation) or for any other purpose (except to absorb bad debt losses). As of September 30, 2011, the Bank’s Excess for tax purposes totaled approximately $6.7 million.

Iowa Taxation. The Bank files Iowa franchise tax returns. Meta Financial and First Services Financial, a subsidiary of the Bank, file a consolidated Iowa corporation tax return on a fiscal year-end basis.

Iowa imposes a franchise tax on the taxable income of mutual and stock savings banks and commercial banks. The tax rate is 5%, which may effectively be increased, in individual cases, by application of a minimum tax provision. Taxable income under the franchise tax is generally similar to taxable income under the federal corporate income tax, except that, under the Iowa franchise tax, no deduction is allowed for Iowa franchise tax payments and taxable income includes interest on state and municipal obligations. Interest on U.S. obligations is taxable under the Iowa franchise tax and under the federal corporate income tax. The taxable income for Iowa franchise tax purposes is apportioned to Iowa through the use of a one-factor formula consisting of gross receipts only.

Taxable income under the Iowa corporate income tax is generally similar to taxable income under the federal corporate income tax, except that, under the Iowa tax, no deduction is allowed for Iowa income tax payments; interest from state and municipal obligations is included in income; interest from U.S. obligations is excluded from income; and 50% of federal corporate income tax payments are deductible from income. The Iowa corporate income tax rates range from 6% to 12% and may be effectively increased, in individual cases, by application of a minimum tax provision.

South Dakota Taxation. The Bank files a South Dakota franchise tax return due to its operations in Sioux Falls and Brookings. The South Dakota franchise tax is imposed on depository institutions and trust companies. The Company and the Bank’s subsidiaries are therefore not subject to the South Dakota franchise tax.

South Dakota imposes a franchise tax on the taxable income of depository institutions and trust companies at the rate of 6%. Taxable income under the franchise tax is generally similar to taxable income under the federal corporate income tax, except that, under the South Dakota franchise tax, no deduction is allowed for state income and franchise taxes, income from municipal obligations exempt from federal taxes are included in the franchise taxable income, and there is a deduction allowed for federal income taxes accrued for the fiscal year. The taxable income for South Dakota franchise tax purposes is apportioned to South Dakota through the use of a three-factor formula consisting of tangible real and personal property, payroll and gross receipts.

Delaware Taxation. As a Delaware holding company, Meta Financial is exempted from Delaware corporate income tax but is required to file an annual report with and pay an annual fee to the State of Delaware. Meta Financial is also subject to an annual franchise tax imposed by the State of Delaware.

 
45


Competition

The Company’s Retail Banking operation faces strong competition, both in originating real estate and other loans and in attracting deposits. Competition in originating real estate loans comes primarily from commercial banks, savings banks, credit unions, captive finance companies, insurance companies, and mortgage bankers making loans secured by real estate located in the Company’s market area. Commercial banks and credit unions provide vigorous competition in consumer lending. The Company competes for real estate and other loans principally on the basis of the quality of services it provides to borrowers, interest rates and loan fees it charges, and the types of loans it originates.

The Company’s Retail Banking operation attracts deposits through its Retail Banking offices, primarily from the communities in which those Retail Banking offices are located; therefore, competition for those deposits is principally from other commercial banks, savings banks, credit unions and brokerage offices located in the same communities. The Company competes for these deposits by offering a variety of deposit accounts at competitive rates, convenient business hours, and convenient branch locations with interbranch deposit and withdrawal privileges at each.

The Company’s payment systems division serves customers nationally and faces competition from large commercial banks and specialty providers of electronic payments processing and servicing, including prepaid, debit, and credit card issuers, ACH processors, and ATM network sponsors. Many of these national players are aggressive competitors, leveraging relationships and economies of scale.

Employees

At September 30, 2011, the Company and its subsidiaries had a total of 389 full-time equivalent employees. The Company’s employees are not represented by any collective bargaining group. Management considers its employee relations to be good.

Executive Officer of the Company Who Is Not A Director

The following information as to the business experience during the past five years is provided with respect to an executive officer of the Company who is not serving on the Company’s Board of Directors. There are no arrangements or understandings between such person named and any persons pursuant to which such officer was selected.

Mr. David W. Leedom, age 57, is Executive Vice President, Secretary, Treasurer, and Chief Financial Officer of the Company after being appointed to the position on January 28, 2008. Additionally, Mr. Leedom is a member of the Executive Committees for both the Company and the Bank. Mr. Leedom has over 25 years of experience in the banking and financial services industry to the company. Mr. Leedom previously served as Senior Vice President of Portfolio Credit and Business Analytics at the Bank from January 2007 to October 2007 when he was appointed Acting Chief Financial Officer. He previously served as a Senior and as an Executive Vice President for BankFirst for 11 years prior to joining Meta in January 2007; his experience at BankFirst included his positions as EVP of Accounting and Finance and Credit Portfolio Management. Mr. Leedom’s experience also includes 11 years at Citibank. Mr. Leedom received a Bachelor of Business Administration in Accounting degree from the University of Iowa.

Risk Factors

Factors that, individually or in the aggregate, we think could cause our actual results to differ materially from expected and historical results include those described below as well as other risks and factors identified from time to time in our SEC filings. The Company’s business could be harmed by any of the risks noted below. The trading price of the Company’s common stock could decline due to any of these risks, and you may lose all or part of your investment. In assessing these risks, you should also refer to the other information contained in this annual report on Form 10-K, including the Company’s financial statements and related notes.

 
46


Risks Related to Our Industry and Business

Difficult economic and market conditions have adversely affected our industry.

Dramatic declines in the housing market, with decreasing home prices and increasing delinquencies and foreclosures, have negatively impacted the credit performance of mortgage and construction loans and resulted in significant write-downs of assets by many financial institutions across the United States. General downward economic trends, low growth, reduced availability of commercial credit and continued levels of high unemployment have negatively impacted the credit performance of commercial and consumer credit, resulting in additional write-downs. Concerns over the stability of the financial markets and the economy have resulted in decreased lending by financial institutions to their customers and to each other. This market turmoil and tightening of credit has led to increased commercial and consumer deficiencies, lack of customer confidence, increased market volatility and widespread reduction in general business activity. Financial institutions have experienced decreased access to deposits and borrowings. The resulting economic pressure on consumers and businesses and the lack of confidence in the financial markets may adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and stock price. A worsening of these conditions would likely exacerbate the adverse effects of these difficult market conditions on us and others in the financial institutions industry. In particular, we may face the following risks in connection with these events:

• Separate and apart from recent enforcement orders issued against the Bank and the Company, we face increased regulation of our industry. Compliance with such regulation may increase our costs and limit our ability to pursue business opportunities;

• Customer demand for loans secured by real estate could be reduced due to weaker economic conditions, an increase in unemployment, a decrease in real estate values or an increase in interest rates;

• The process we use to estimate losses inherent in our credit exposure requires difficult, subjective and complex judgments, including forecasts of economic conditions and how these economic conditions might impair the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans. The level of uncertainty concerning economic conditions may adversely affect the accuracy of our estimates which may, in turn, impact the reliability of the process;

• The value of the portfolio of investment securities that we hold, including our trust preferred securities, may be adversely affected; and

• If, due to financial setbacks or other regulatory action, we may be required to pay significantly higher FDIC insurance premiums in the future. See “– Regulation.”

The full impact of the recently enacted Dodd-Frank Act is currently unknown given that many of the details and substance of the new laws will be determined through agency rulemaking.

The full compliance burden and impact on our operations and profitability with respect to the Dodd-Frank Act are currently unknown, as the Dodd-Frank Act delegates to various federal agencies the task of implementing its many provisions through regulation. Hundreds of new federal regulations, studies and reports are required under the Dodd-Frank Act and not all of them have been finalized. Although certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act have been implemented (such as the creation of the CFPB and the transfer of regulation of federal savings banks like the Bank to the OCC), federal rules and policies in this area will be further developing for months and years to come. Based on the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act and anticipated implementing regulations, it is highly likely that banks and thrifts as well as their holding companies will be subject to significantly increased regulation and compliance obligations that expose us to noncompliance risk and consequences.

 
47


OTS and transfer of the OTS' supervisory and rulemaking functions to various federal banking agencies has changed the way that we are regulated.

Both the Bank and Company have transitioned to the jurisdiction of new primary federal regulators, which changes the way both are regulated. Specifically, the OTS' supervisory and rulemaking functions (except for consumer protection) relating to all federal savings associations were transferred to the OCC on July 21, 2011, while the OTS' supervisory and rulemaking functions relating to savings and loan holding companies and their non-depository institution subsidiaries were transferred to the FRB on the same date. While the OCC and FRB are directed to implement existing OTS regulations, orders, resolutions, determinations and agreements for thrifts and their holding companies under the HOLA, the transition of supervisory functions from the OTS to these agencies could alter the operations of the Bank and Company so as to be more closely aligned with the OCC's and FRB's respective supervision of national banks and their bank holding companies. As a result of these transitions, we may see changes in the way we are supervised, and may experience operational challenges with respect to this transition to our new regulators. The Bank is currently being examined by the OCC.

The CFPB may reshape the consumer financial laws through rulemaking and enforcement of unfair, deceptive or abusive practices, which may directly impact the business operations of depository institutions offering consumer financial products or services including the Bank.

The CFPB has broad rulemaking authority to administer and carry out the purposes and objectives of the "Federal consumer financial laws, and to prevent evasions thereof," with respect to all financial institutions that offer financial products and services to consumers. The CFPB is also authorized to prescribe rules, applicable to any covered person or service provider, identifying and prohibiting acts or practices that are "unfair, deceptive, or abusive" in connection with any transaction with a consumer for a consumer financial product or service, or the offering of a consumer financial product or service ("UDAAP authority"). The term “abusive” is new and untested, and we cannot predict how it will be enforced. The full reach and impact of the CFPB's broad new rulemaking powers and UDAAP authority on the operations of financial institutions offering consumer financial products or services is currently unknown. Notwithstanding, insured depository institutions with assets of $10 billion or less (such as the Bank) will continue to be supervised and examined by their primary federal regulators, rather than the CFPB, with respect to compliance with federal consumer protection laws.

Our most recent Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) rating could have a negative effect on the OCC's review of certain banking applications.

Under the CRA, the Bank is evaluated periodically by its primary federal banking regulator to determine if it is meeting its continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with its safe and sound operation to help meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low and moderate income neighborhoods. In the Bank’s most recent CRA examination, notwithstanding that the Bank’s record was consistent with an overall rating of “Satisfactory,” the Bank received a “Needs to Improve” rating due to the criticized credit practices associated with the iAdvance product, which the Bank is no longer offering. The CRA requires the OCC, our new regulator, to take such rating into account in considering an application for any of the following: (i) the establishment of a domestic branch; (ii) the relocation of its main office or of a branch; (iii) the merger or consolidation with or acquisition of assets or assumption of liabilities of an insured depository institution; or (iv) the conversion of the Bank to a national charter. If the Bank submitted any of the above-listed applications, the OCC may consider the Bank's overall “Needs to Improve” rating negatively.

Legislative and regulatory initiatives taken to date may not achieve their intended objectives; proposed and future initiatives may substantially increase compliance burdens and further impact our financial condition or results of operations.

Legislative and regulatory initiatives taken to date by Congress and the federal banking regulators to address financial regulatory reform may not achieve their intended objectives, thereby requiring additional legislation or regulation of the financial services industry. Furthermore, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and other international bodies comprised of banking regulators have committed to raise capital standards and liquidity buffers within the banking system by imposing new requirements. Such proposals may impose more stringent standards than currently applicable or anticipated with respect to capital and liquidity requirements for depository institutions. As of the date of this filing, none of the federal banking agencies has released proposed rules related to the current Basel Committee proposal (Basel III); however, it is generally anticipated within the industry that the Federal Reserve will place the burden of proof on individual institutions to demonstrate that they are on a trajectory to comply with higher capital requirements under Basel III, prior to its implementation, and institutions that fail to meet that burden may be subject to regulatory restrictions that curtail dividends, limit growth or similar actions. We cannot predict whether such proposals will ultimately be adopted, or the impact that such proposals, if adopted, would have upon our financial condition or results of operations.

 
48


We have a concentration of our assets in mortgage-backed securities.

As of September 30, 2011 approximately 46.3% of the Bank’s assets were invested in mortgage-backed securities.

The Company’s mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consists primarily of securities issued under government-sponsored agency programs, including those of Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, the latter two of which are in conservatorship. The Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac certificates are modified pass-through mortgage-backed securities that represent undivided interests in underlying pools of fixed-rate, or certain types of adjustable-rate, predominantly single-family and, to a lesser extent, multi-family residential mortgages issued by these government-sponsored entities. Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac generally provide the certificate holder a guarantee of timely payments of interest, whether or not collected. Ginnie Mae’s guarantee to the holder is timely payments of principal and interest, backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. Privately issued mortgage pass-through certificates generally provide no guarantee as to timely payment of interest or principal, and reliance is placed on the creditworthiness of the issuer.

Mortgage-backed securities generally increase the quality of the Company’s assets by virtue of the insurance or guarantees that back them, are more liquid than individual mortgage loans and may be used to collateralize borrowings or other obligations of the Company.

While mortgage-backed securities carry a reduced credit risk as compared to whole loans, such securities remain subject to the risk that a fluctuating interest rate environment, along with other factors such as the geographic distribution of the underlying mortgage loans, may alter the prepayment rate of such mortgage loans and so affect both the prepayment speed, and value, of such securities. The prepayment risk associated with mortgage-backed securities is monitored periodically, and prepayment rate assumptions adjusted as appropriate to update the Company’s mortgage-backed securities accounting and asset/liability reports.

We recorded other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") charges in our trust preferred securities ("TRUPS") portfolio in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2010, and we could record additional losses in the future.

We determine the fair value of our investment securities based on GAAP and three levels of informational inputs that may be used to measure fair value. The price at which a security may be sold in a market transaction could be significantly lower than the quoted market price for the security, particularly if the quoted market price is based on infrequent trading history, the market for the security is illiquid, or a significant amount of securities are being sold.

In fiscal 2011, there were no other-than-temporary impairments recorded. In fiscal 2010, the other-than-temporary impairments recorded against the trust preferred securities were $350,000. No other-than-temporary impairments were recorded against earnings during fiscal 2009.

The valuation of our TRUPS will continue to be influenced by external market and other factors, including implementation of Securities and Exchange Commission and Financial Accounting Standards Board guidance on fair value accounting, the financial condition of specific issuers deferral and default rates of specific issuer financial institutions, rating agency actions, and the prices at which observable market transactions occur. If we are required to record additional OTTI charges on our TRUPS portfolio, we could experience potentially significant earnings losses as well as an adverse impact to our capital position.

 
49


Under the recently enacted Dodd-Frank Act, TRUPS issued on or after May 19, 2010 are no longer eligible for inclusion in Tier 1 capital. For trust preferred securities issued before May 19, 2010, regulatory capital deductions will generally be required during a phase in period from January 1, 2013 to January 1, 2016; however, depository institution holding companies with assets of less than $15 billion as of year-end 2009 enjoy a permanent grandfather right with respect to such securities for purposes of calculating regulatory capital.

Risks Related to the Banking Industry

Our reputation and business could be damaged by our entry into the Consent Orders and other negative publicity.

Reputational risk, or the risk to our business, earnings and capital from negative publicity, is inherent in our business. Negative publicity can result from actual or alleged conduct in a number of areas, including legal and regulatory compliance, lending practices, corporate governance, litigation, inadequate protection of customer data, ethical behavior of our employees, and from actions taken by regulators and others as a result of that conduct. Damage to our reputation, including as a result of negative publicity associated with the Consent Orders as well as any future supervisory action, could impact our ability to attract new and maintain existing loan and deposit customers, employees and business relationships, particularly with respect to our MPS division.

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud.

There have been a number of publicized cases involving fraud or other misconduct by employees of financial services firms in recent years. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information. Employee fraud, errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to civil claims for negligence. See Item 3. “Legal Proceedings.”

Although we maintain a system of internal controls and procedures designed to reduce the risk of loss from employee or customer fraud or misconduct and employee errors as well as insurance coverage to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud, these internal controls may fail to prevent or detect such an occurrence, or such an occurrence may not be insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits.

In addition, there have also been a number of cases where financial institutions have been the victim of fraud related to unauthorized wire and Automated Clearinghouse transactions. The facts and circumstances of each case vary but generally involve criminals posing as customers (i.e., stealing bank customers' identities) to transfer funds out of the institution quickly in an effort to place the funds beyond recovery prior to detection. Although we have policies and procedures in place to verify the authenticity of our customers and prevent identity theft, we can provide no assurances that these policies and procedures will prevent all fraudulent transfers. In addition, although we have safeguards in place, it is possible that our computer systems could be infiltrated by hackers or other intruders. We can provide no assurances that these safeguards will prevent all unauthorized infiltrations. Identity theft and successful unauthorized intrusions could result in reputational damage and financial losses to the Company. See "Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."

Certain provisions of the Volcker Rule (as set forth in the Dodd-Frank Act) may affect our operations.

The Federal Reserve, along with the FDIC, the OCC, the SEC and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, released in October 2011 a proposed rule implementing the Volcker Rule as set forth in Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act. Section 619 generally prohibits insured depository institutions, bank holding companies and their subsidiaries or affiliates from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of any security, derivative and certain other financial instruments for a banking entity’s own account, subject to certain exemptions. Section 619 also prohibits owning, sponsoring or having certain relationships with a hedge fund or private equity fund, subject to certain exemptions. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act prohibits banking entities from engaging in an exempted transaction or activity if it would involve or result in a material conflict of interest between the banking entity and its clients, customers or counterparties, or that would result in a material exposure to high-risk assets or trading strategies, as defined therein. In addition, banking entities are prohibited from engaging in an exempted transaction or activity if it would pose a threat to the safety and soundness of the banking entity or to the financial stability of the United States. Transactions in certain instruments (such as obligations of the U.S. government or a U.S. government agency) are exempt from these prohibitions. Although a final rule implementing Section 619 has not yet been adopted by federal regulators, if adopted as drafted, the effect on the Company and the Bank is undetermined.

 
50


Changes in economic and political conditions could adversely affect the Company’s earnings, as the Company’s borrowers’ ability to repay loans and the value of the collateral securing the Company’s loans decline.

The Company’s success depends, to a certain extent, upon economic and political conditions, local and national, as well as governmental monetary policies. Conditions such as inflation, recession, unemployment, changes in interest rates, money supply and other factors beyond the Company’s control may adversely affect the Company’s asset quality, deposit levels and loan demand and, therefore, the Company’s earnings. Because the Company has a significant amount of real estate loans, decreases in real estate values could adversely affect the value of property used as collateral. Among other things, adverse changes in the economy, including but not limited to the current economic downturn, may also have a negative effect on the ability of the Company’s borrowers to make timely repayments of their loans, which would have an adverse impact on the Company’s earnings. In addition, the vast majority of the Company’s loans are to individuals and businesses in the Company’s market area. Consequently, any economic decline in the Company’s market area could have an adverse impact on the Company’s earnings.

Recessionary environment may adversely impact the Company’s earnings and continuing and new governmental initiatives may not prove effective.

The national and global economic downturn has recently resulted in heightened levels of market volatility locally, nationally and internationally. This downturn has depressed the overall market value of financial institutions, and may limit or impede industry access to capital, or have a material adverse effect on the financial condition or results of operations of banking companies in general, including the Company, with respect to, for example, the establishment of reserves should conditions deteriorate further. Although the U.S. Department of the Treasury and the FDIC, among others, implemented programs in an effort to stabilize the national economy, the ultimate effectiveness of these programs remains uncertain at this time. Further, failure of the U.S. Congress to address the expanding national deficit, as well as problems associated with sovereign debt in Europe, may worsen the U.S. economy, both nationally and locally, causing an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Changes in interest rates could adversely affect the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.

The Company’s earnings depend substantially on the Company’s interest rate spread, which is the difference between (i) the rates we earn on loans, securities and other earning assets, and (ii) the interest rates we pay on deposits and other borrowings. These rates are highly sensitive to many factors beyond the Company’s control, including general economic conditions and the policies of various governmental and regulatory authorities. As market interest rates rise, we will have competitive pressures to increase the rates we pay on deposits, which may result in a decrease of the Company’s net interest income. Conversely, if interest rates fall, yields on loans and investments may fall. Because a significant portion of the Company’s deposit portfolio is in non-interest bearing accounts, such a change in rates would likely result in a decrease in the Company’s net interest income. For additional information, see Part II, Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.”

 
51


The Company operates in a highly regulated environment, and changes in laws and regulations to which we are subject may adversely affect the Company’s results of operations.

The Company and the Bank operate in a highly regulated environment and are subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by the OCC, the FDIC and the Federal Reserve. As of July 21, 2011, the Company has been supervised by the Federal Reserve, and the Bank has been supervised by the OCC and the FDIC. See Item 1 “Business – Regulation” herein. Applicable laws and regulations may change and the enforcement of existing laws and regulations may vary when actions are evaluated by these new regulators, and there is no assurance that such changes will not adversely affect the Company’s business. Regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities, including but not limited to the imposition of restrictions on the operation of an institution, the classification of assets by the institution and the adequacy of an institution’s allowance for loan losses. Any change in such regulation and oversight, whether in the form of restrictions on activities, regulatory policy, regulations, or legislation, including but not limited to changes in the regulations governing savings banks, could have a material impact on the Company’s operations. It is unknown at this time to what extent legislation will be passed into law or regulatory proposals will be adopted, or the effect that such passage or adoption will have on the banking industry or the Company.

Changes in technology could be costly.

The banking industry is undergoing technological innovation at a fast pace. To keep up with its competition, the Company needs to stay abreast of innovations and evaluate those technologies that will enable it to compete on a cost-effective basis. This is especially true with respect to MPS. The cost of such technology, including personnel, can be high in both absolute and relative terms. There can be no assurance, given the fast pace of change and innovation, that the Company’s technology, either purchased or developed internally, will meet or continue to meet the needs of the Company.

Risks Related to the Company’s Business

The entry into the Consent Orders has imposed certain restrictions and requirements upon the Company and the Bank and we cannot predict the possibility of future regulatory action.

As has been described in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, the Company and the Bank entered into Consent Orders with the OTS in July 2011. Pursuant to the Consent Orders, the Company and the Bank are required to take certain actions and implement certain policies and procedures. These corrective actions have resulted in increased compliance costs for internal and external resources and have been a diversion from the Bank’s continuing operations. Although the Company and the Bank believe they are taking appropriate actions to comply with the Consent Orders, the Federal Reserve and the OCC will make such determinations during the course of their supervisory examinations; one of which is now pending with the OCC; any failures to comply with the Consent Orders could lead to additional regulatory actions by such regulators. See “Business – Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The compliance obligations and restrictions on our interest payments and dividends under the recent OTS enforcement actions may have an adverse effect on us and preclude payments to holders of our securities.

Among other things, the Consent Orders require the Company and Bank to submit to the OTS (or its successor) various management and compliance plans and programs to address the matters initially identified in the OTS supervisory directives as well as plans for enhancing Company and Bank capital, and require OTS non-objection for Company cash dividends, distributions, share repurchases, payments of interest or principal on debt and incurrence of debt. Our compliance with the Consent Orders will be subject to the review and supervision of the OCC with respect the Bank and the Federal Reserve Board with respect to the Company. There can be no assurance that we can fully comply with the requirement of the Consent Orders or receive non-objection to our payment of dividends and interest or any other activity for which non-objection or approval is required. See “Business – Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 
52


The OCC and Federal Reserve are now our banking regulators and we may not be able to comply with applicable banking regulations and the terms of the Consent Orders to their satisfaction.

As a result of the integration of the OTS into the OCC, our on-going compliance with applicable banking laws and the Consent Orders will be subject to the review and supervision of the OCC with respect the Bank and the Federal Reserve with respect to the Company, both of which are new bank regulators for us as of July 21, 2011. We cannot predict how the OCC and the Federal Reserve will evaluate the Bank and us, respectively, notwithstanding our intention to cooperate fully with our new regulators. Our bank regulators have broad discretionary powers to enforce banking laws and regulations and may seek to take informal or formal supervisory action if they deem such actions are necessary or required. In connection with its new supervision authority with respect to savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve issued a proposed rule in April 2011 that announced that its supervision would be “more intensive” than our former regulator, the OTS. Corrective steps could result in, among other things, presently unforeseen operating limitations and increased compliance costs for internal and external resources.

The Company operates in an extremely competitive market, and the Company’s business will suffer if it is unable to compete effectively.

The Company encounters significant competition in the Company’s market area from other commercial banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, mortgage banking firms, consumer finance companies, securities brokerage firms, insurance companies, money market mutual funds and other financial intermediaries. Many of the Company’s competitors have substantially greater resources and lending limits and may offer services that the Company does not or cannot provide. The Company’s profitability depends upon the Company’s continued ability to compete successfully in the Company’s market area. MPS operates on a national scale against competitors with substantially greater resources and limited barriers to entry, as well as the fact that most competitors are not operating under restrictions similar to those imposed upon the Company and the Bank in the Consent Orders. The success of MPS depends upon the Company’s and the Bank’s ability to satisfy the requirements set forth in their respective Consent Orders and the MPS division’s ability to compete in such an environment.

The Bank is “well capitalized” under existing bank regulations but failure to maintain this designation could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity and results of operations. In addition, our regulator could limit our ability to raise deposits, which could produce serious adverse consequences for our liquidity, financial condition and results of operations.

By letter dated December 28, 2010, the OTS directed the Bank not to increase the amount of brokered deposits from the amount it held at December 28, 2010 without the prior written non-objection of the OTS Regional Director. The Bank believes it did not hold any brokered deposits on December 28, 2010 or thereafter, and therefore does not anticipate seeking approval. At the direction of the OTS, the Bank requested the FDIC to confirm that deposits related to a specific prepaid program were not brokered deposits. The Bank has not yet received a reply from FDIC. At the time the directive was issued, OTS staff stated that it would not seek retroactively to enforce the directive for any growth that occurs subsequent to December 28, 2010, given the Bank's request to the FDIC. The Bank tendered its request to the FDIC in December 2010. The Bank has been advised that the FDIC will consider the Bank's request in the context of its broader industry reevaluation of brokered deposits in general. In addition, under current rules, if a substantial portion of the Bank's deposits are ruled to be "brokered," and should the Bank's primary federal regulator decide to impose a formal individual minimum capital requirement or similar formal requirement on the Bank notwithstanding that the Bank is well-capitalized, the Bank would be prohibited, absent waiver from the FDIC, from utilizing brokered deposits. In either event, unless the Bank receives relief from its regulator or a waiver from the FDIC, such a result could produce serious adverse consequences for the Bank from a liquidity standpoint and could also have serious adverse effects on the Company's financial condition and results of operations.

We derive a significant percentage of our deposits, total assets and income from deposit accounts that we generate through MPS’s customer relationships.

We derive a significant percentage of our deposits, total assets and income from deposit accounts we generate through customer relationships between such third parties and MPS. Deposits related to our top three customers (each, a significant customer) totaled $561.5 million at September 30, 2011. We provide oversight and auditing of such third-party relationships and all such relationships must meet all internal and regulatory requirements. We may exit these relationships if such requirements are not met or if required by our regulators to exit such relationships. We perform liquidity reporting and planning daily and identify and monitor contingent sources of liquidity, such as National CDs, Fed Fund Lines, or Public Fund CDs. If one of these significant customers were to be terminated, it could materially reduce our deposits, assets and income. In addition, pursuant to the Bank’s Consent Order, if one of these relationships were to terminate before the termination of the Consent Order, we would not be able to replace such relationship without first identifying a new contracting party and then obtaining approval to enter into such agreement from the OCC. If such significant customer was not replaced, we may be required to seek higher rate funding sources as compared to the existing customer and interest expense might increase. We may also be required to sell securities or other assets which would reduce revenues and potentially generate losses.

 
53


Our business strategy is utilized by other institutions with which we compete and the Consent Orders prevent us from actively marketing the Bank’s products and services.

Several banking institutions have adopted business goals that are similar to ours, particularly with respect to the MPS division. As a consequence, we have encountered competition in this area and anticipate that we will continue to do so in the future. This competition will likely increase our costs, reduce our revenues or revenue growth, or make it difficult for us to compete effectively in obtaining additional customer relationships. In addition, pursuant to the Consent Orders, we are not allowed to sign any new material agreements with customers unless we are granted specific permission to do so, or until the terms of the Consent Orders are rescinded. As a result, until the terms of the Consent Orders are lifted, we are at a competitive disadvantage with respect to growing the Bank’s profitable MPS division.

Existing insurance policies may not adequately protect the Company and its subsidiaries.

Fidelity, business interruption and property insurance policies are in place with respect to the operations of the Company. Should any event triggering such policies occur, however, it is possible that our policies would not fully reimburse us for the losses we could sustain due to deductible limits, policy limits, coverage limits or other factors.

The loss of key members of the Company’s senior management team could adversely affect the Company’s business.

We believe that the Company’s success depends largely on the efforts and abilities of the Company’s senior management. Their experience and industry contacts significantly benefit us. The competition for qualified personnel in the financial services industry is intense, and the loss of any of the Company’s key personnel or an inability to continue to attract, retain and motivate key personnel could adversely affect the Company’s business.

The Company’s loan portfolio includes loans with a higher risk of loss.

The Company originates commercial mortgage loans, commercial loans, consumer loans, agricultural mortgage loans, agricultural loans and residential mortgage loans. Commercial mortgage, commercial, and consumer loans may expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the collateral securing these loans may not be sold as easily as residential real estate. These loans also have greater credit risk than residential real estate for the following reasons:

 
·
Commercial Mortgage Loans. Repayment is dependent upon income being generated in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service.

 
·
Commercial Loans. Repayment is dependent upon the successful operation of the borrower’s business.

 
·
Consumer Loans. Consumer loans (such as personal lines of credit) are collateralized, if at all, with assets that may not provide an adequate source of payment of the loan due to depreciation, damage, or loss.

 
·
Agricultural Loans. Repayment is dependent upon the successful operation of the business, which is greatly dependent on many things outside the control of either the Bank or the borrowers. These factors include weather, commodity prices, and interest rates, among others.

 
54


If the Company’s actual loan losses exceed the Company’s allowance for loan losses, the Company’s net income will decrease.

The Company makes various assumptions and judgments about the collectibility of the Company’s loan portfolio, including the creditworthiness of the Company’s borrowers and the value of the real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the repayment of the Company’s loans. Despite the Company’s underwriting and monitoring practices, the Company’s loan customers may not repay their loans according to their terms, and the collateral securing the payment of these loans may be insufficient to pay any remaining loan balance. The Company may experience significant loan losses, which could have a material adverse effect on its operating results. Because the Company must use assumptions regarding individual loans and the economy, the current allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover actual loan losses, and increases in the allowance may be necessary. The Company may need to significantly increase the Company’s provision for losses on loans if one or more of the Company’s larger loans or credit relationships becomes delinquent or if we continue to expand the Company’s commercial real estate and commercial lending. In addition, federal and state regulators periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses and may require the Company to increase the Company’s provision for loan losses or recognize loan charge-offs. Material additions to the Company’s allowance would materially decrease the Company’s net income. The Company cannot assure you that its monitoring procedures and policies will reduce certain lending risks or that the Company’s allowance for loan losses will be adequate to cover actual losses.

If the Company forecloses on and takes ownership of real estate collateral property, it may be subject to the increased costs associated with the ownership of real property, resulting in reduced revenues.

The Company may have to foreclose on collateral property to protect its investment and may thereafter own and operate such property. In such case, the Company will be exposed to the risks inherent in the ownership of real estate. The amount that the Company, as a mortgagee, may realize after a default is dependent upon factors outside of the Company’s control, including, but not limited to: (i) general or local economic conditions; (ii) neighborhood values; (iii) interest rates; (iv) real estate tax rates; (v) operating expenses of the mortgaged properties; (vi) supply of and demand for rental units or properties; (vii) ability to obtain and maintain adequate occupancy of the properties; (viii) zoning laws; (ix) governmental rules, regulations and fiscal policies; and (x) acts of God. Certain expenditures associated with the ownership of real estate, principally real estate taxes and maintenance costs, may adversely affect the income from the real estate. Therefore, the cost of operating a real property may exceed the rental income earned from such property, and the Company may have to advance funds in order to protect the Company’s investment, or may be required to dispose of the real property at a loss. The foregoing expenditures and costs could adversely affect the Company’s ability to generate revenues, resulting in reduced levels of profitability.

Environmental liability associated with commercial lending could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

In the course of the Company’s business, it may acquire, through foreclosure, commercial properties securing loans that are in default. There is a risk that hazardous substances could be discovered on those properties. In this event, the Company could be required to remove the substances from and remediate the properties at its own cost and expense. The cost of removal and environmental remediation could be substantial. The Company may not have adequate remedies against the owners of the properties or other responsible parties and could find it difficult or impossible to sell the affected properties. These events could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and operating results.

If the Company fails to maintain an effective system of internal control over financial reporting, it may not be able to accurately report the Company’s financial results or prevent fraud, and, as a result, investors and depositors could lose confidence in the Company’s financial reporting, which could adversely affect the Company’s business, the trading price of the Company’s stock and the Company’s ability to attract additional deposits.

In recent years, the Company has been required to include in its annual reports filed with the SEC a report of the Company’s management regarding internal control over financial reporting. We have documented and evaluated the Company’s internal control over financial reporting in order to satisfy the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and SEC rules and regulations, which require an annual management report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, including, among other matters, management’s assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. In order to comply with this requirement, management retained outside consultants to assist the Company in (i) assessing and documenting the adequacy of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, (ii) improving control processes, where appropriate, and (iii) verifying through testing or other means that controls are functioning as documented. Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting is contained in Item 9A below. If the Company fails to identify and correct any significant deficiencies in the design or operating effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting or fails to prevent fraud, current and potential stockholders and depositors could lose confidence in the Company’s financial reporting, which could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations, the trading price of the Company’s stock, and the Company’s ability to attract additional deposits.

 
55


No material weaknesses have been identified in connection with the Company’s fiscal year 2011 audit. If material weaknesses are identified in the future, such weaknesses could have a material impact on the profitability and performance of the Company.

A breach of information security or compliance breach by one of the Company’s agents or vendors could negatively affect the Company’s reputation and business.

The Company depends on data processing, communication and information exchange on a variety of computing platforms and networks and over the internet. No system, including ours, is entirely free from vulnerability to attack, despite safeguards. Additionally, the Company relies on and does business with a variety of third-party service providers, agents and vendors with respect to the Company’s business, data and communications needs. If information security is breached, or one of the Company’s agents or vendors breaches compliance procedures, information could be lost or misappropriated, resulting in financial loss or costs to the Company or damages to others. These costs or losses could materially exceed the Company’s amount of insurance coverage, if any, which would adversely affect the Company’s business.

Risks Related to the Company’s Stock

The price of the Company’s common stock may be volatile, which may result in losses for investors.

The market price for shares of the Company’s common stock has been volatile in the past, and several factors could cause the price to fluctuate substantially in the future. These factors include:

 
·
announcements of developments related to the Company’s business,

 
·
fluctuations in the Company’s results of operations,

 
·
sales of substantial amounts of the Company’s securities into the marketplace,

 
·
general conditions in the Company’s banking niche or the worldwide economy,

 
·
a shortfall in revenues or earnings compared to securities analysts’ expectations,

 
·
lack of an active trading market for the common stock,

 
·
changes in analysts’ recommendations or projections, and

 
·
the Company’s announcement of new acquisitions or other projects.

The market price of the Company’s common stock may fluctuate significantly in the future, and these fluctuations may be unrelated to the Company’s performance. General market price declines or market volatility in the future could adversely affect the price of the Company’s common stock, and the current market price may not be indicative of future market prices.

 
56


An investment in Company common stock is not an insured deposit.

Our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss by the FDIC, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. Investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk Factors” section and is subject to market forces that affect the price of common stock in any company. As a result, if you hold or acquire our common stock, it is possible that you may lose all or a portion of your investment.

The Company’s common stock is thinly traded, and thus your ability to sell shares or purchase additional shares of the Company’s common stock will be limited, and the market price at any time may not reflect true value.

Your ability to sell shares of the Company’s common stock or purchase additional shares largely depends upon the existence of an active market for the common stock. The Company’s common stock is quoted on NASDAQ Global Market, but the volume of trades on any given day is light, and you may be unable to find a buyer for shares you wish to sell or a seller of additional shares you wish to purchase. In addition, a fair valuation of the purchase or sales price of a share of common stock also depends upon active trading, and thus the price you receive for a thinly traded stock, such as the Company’s common stock, may not reflect its true value.

Future sales or additional issuances of the Company’s capital stock may depress prices of shares of the Company’s common stock or otherwise dilute the book value of shares then outstanding.

Sales of a substantial amount of the Company’s capital stock in the public market or the issuance of a significant number of shares could adversely affect the market price for shares of the Company’s common stock. As of September 30, 2011, the Company was authorized to issue up to 5,200,000 shares of common stock, of which 3,146,867 shares were outstanding, and 226,132 shares were held as treasury stock. The Company was also authorized to issue up to 800,000 shares of preferred stock, none of which is outstanding or reserved for issuance. Accordingly, without further stockholder approval, the Company may issue up to 2,053,133 additional shares of common stock. This factor may affect the market price for shares of the Company’s common stock.

Federal regulations may inhibit a takeover, prevent a transaction you may favor or limit the Company’s growth opportunities, which could cause the market price of the Company’s common stock to decline.

Certain provisions of the Company’s charter documents and federal regulations could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or of discouraging a third party from attempting to acquire, control of the company. In addition, the Company must obtain approval from regulatory authorities before it can acquire control of any other company.

The Company may not be able to pay dividends in the future in accordance with past practice.

The Company pays a quarterly dividend to stockholders. The payment of dividends is subject to legal and regulatory restrictions as well as a requirement for prior approval by the Federal Reserve pursuant to the Consent Orders. Any payment of dividends in the future will depend, in large part, on the Company’s earnings, capital requirements, financial condition, regulatory review, and other factors considered relevant by the Company’s Board of Directors.

Our agricultural loans are subject to factors beyond the Bank’s control.

The agricultural community is subject to commodity price fluctuations. Although our agricultural loans are a relatively limited part of our overall portfolio, extended periods of low commodity prices, higher input costs, or poor weather conditions could result in reduced profit margins, reducing demand for goods and services provided by agriculture-related businesses, which in turn, could affect other businesses in the Company’s market area.

 
57


Risks Related to Meta Payment Systems®, a division of the Bank

MPS’ products and services are highly regulated financial products subject to extensive supervision and regulation.

The products and services offered by MPS are highly regulated by federal banking agencies, state banking agencies, and other federal and state regulators. Some of the laws and related regulations affecting its operations include consumer protection laws, escheat laws, privacy laws, anti-money laundering laws and data protection laws. Compliance with the relevant legal paradigm in which the division operates is costly and requires significant personnel resources, as well as extensive contacts with outside lawyers and consultants hired by MPS to stay abreast of the applicable regulatory schemes.

The Dodd-Frank Act’s restrictions with respect to the cap on debit card interchange could negatively affect the Bank’s business.

On June 29, 2011, the Federal Reserve issued a rule establishing standards for debit card interchange fees and prohibiting network exclusivity arrangements and routing restrictions (the “Debit Card Rule”). The issuance of the Debit Card Rule was required by the Dodd-Frank Act. Pursuant to the Debit Card Rule, the maximum permissible interchange fee that an issuer may receive for an electronic debit transaction will be $0.21 per transaction and five basis points multiplied by the value of the transaction. The Federal Reserve also approved an interim final rule that allows for an upward adjustment of no more than $0.01 to an issuer's debit card interchange fee if the issuer develops and implements policies and procedures reasonably designed to achieve the fraud-prevention standards set out in the interim final rule. Eligibility for the assessment of this fee must be certified by the issuing bank. As set forth in the issuing release, when the maximum interchange fee is combined with fraud-prevention assessment, an issuing bank could receive an interchange fee of up to approximately 24 cents for the average debit card transaction, which is valued at $38 according to the Federal Reserve. In accordance with the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, issuers that, together with their affiliates, have assets of less than $10 billion (like the Bank) are exempt from the debit card interchange fee standards. With respect to network exclusivity and merchant routing restrictions, it is now required that all debit cards participate in at least two unaffiliated networks so that the transactions initiated using those debit cards will have at least two independent routing channels.

While some proposed legislation would benefit MPS, it is possible that new legislation or more stringent focus by banking agencies could further restrict MPS’ current operations or change the regulatory environment in which the division’s customers operate.

Although it is possible that some legislation under consideration could have either a positive or de minimis impact on its operations and profitability it is also possible that any new legislation affecting the operations of MPS or its customers, some of which are also regulated entities, would have a negative impact on the conduct of the relevant business. There is no way to quantify the impact that such changes could have on the profitability or operations of MPS at this time given the unpredictable nature of the risk.

In addition to the relevant legal paradigm set forth above, it should also be noted that there has been concern within the bank regulatory environment over the use of credit and, in particular, prepaid cards as a means by which to illegally launder and move money. The U.S. Treasury’s Financial Crimes Enforcement Network has recently issued rules related to providers of “prepaid access” which have left certain issues unresolved related to its regulatory requirements. Although the Bank will continue to work with its regulators to provide information about its operations as well as the state of the prepaid card industry, we believe such concerns in general will continue for the foreseeable future for the entire banking industry, with a continued emphasis on heightened compliance expectations. See “Business Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 
58


MPS, through the Bank, owns or is seeking a number of patents, trademarks and other forms of intellectual property with respect to the operation of its business and the protection of such intellectual property may in the future require material expenditures.

In its operations, MPS, through the Bank, is seeking protection for various forms of intellectual property. No assurance can be given that such protection will be granted. In addition, given the competitive market environment of its business, the Bank must be vigilant in ensuring that its patents and other intellectual property are protected and not exploited by unlicensed third parties.

The Bank must also protect itself and defend against intellectual property challenges initiated by third parties making various claims against MPS. With respect to these claims, regardless of whether we are pursuing our claims against perceived infringers or defending our intellectual property from third parties asserting various claims of infringement, it is possible that significant personnel time and monetary resources could be used to pursue or defend such claims.

It should also be noted that intellectual property risks extend to foreign countries whose protections of such property are not as extensive as those in the United States. As such, MPS may need to spend additional sums to ensure that its intellectual property protections are maximized globally. Moreover, should there be a material, improper use of the Bank’s intellectual property, this could have an impact on the division’s operations.

Contracts with third-parties, some of which are material to the Company, may not be renewed, may be renegotiated on terms that are not as favorable, may not be fulfilled or could be subject to cancellation by regulatory authorities.

The Bank has entered into numerous contracts with third parties with respect to the operations of its business. In some instances, the third parties provide services to MPS; in other instances, MPS provides products and services to such third parties. Were such agreements not to be renewed by the third party or were such agreements to be renewed on terms less favorable, such actions could have a material impact on the division’s profitability and deposit levels.

Similarly, were one of these parties unable to meet their obligations to us for any reason (including but not limited to bankruptcy, computer or other technological interruptions or failures, personnel loss or acts of God), we may need to seek alternative service providers and the terms with such alternate providers may not be as favorable as those currently in place. In addition, were such failures to cause a material disruption in our ability to service our customers, it is possible that our customer base would shrink. Moreover, were the disruptions in our ability to provide services significant, this could negatively affect the perception of our business in the card industry.

In addition, as described earlier, in the Consent Orders our regulator noted deficiencies with respect to our third party relationships. As a result, we have initiated a review of our auditing program for third parties with whom we contract (as well as other business changes required both by the Consent Orders and general business practices) and have made certain business decisions related to determinations reached by our auditing personnel. If we are unsuccessful in the development and/or implementation of our third party auditing program, it is possible that the OCC could order us to abrogate certain contracts or take other supervisory actions against us which would further impact the MPS business, which could have an adverse impact on our financial condition or results of operations. See “Business Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation- OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Costs of conforming products and services to the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standards (the “PCI DSS”) are costly and could continue to affect the operations of MPS.

The PCI DSS is a multifaceted standard that includes data security management, policies and procedures, as well as other protective measures, that was created by the largest credit card associations in the world in an effort to protect the nonpublic personal information of all types of cardholders, including prepaid cardholders and holders of network branded credit cards (such as Discover, MasterCard, and Visa). The PCI DSS mandates a prescribed technical foundation for the collection, storage and transmission of cardholder data and also contains significant provisions regarding the testing of security protections by various entities in the payment card industry, including MPS. Compliance with the PCI DSS is costly and changes to the standards could have an equal, or greater, effect on profitability of the relevant business division.

 
59


The potential for fraud in the card payment industry is significant.

Issuers of prepaid and credit cards have suffered significant losses in recent years with respect to the theft of cardholder data that has been illegally exploited for personal gain. The theft of such information is regularly reported and affects not only individuals but businesses as well (albeit to a lesser degree). Many types of credit card fraud exist, including the counterfeiting of cards and “skimming.” “Skimming” is the term for a specialized type of credit card information theft whereby, typically, an employee of a merchant will copy the cardholder’s number and security code (either by handwriting the information onto a piece of paper, entering such information into a keypad or other device, or using a handheld device which “reads” and then stores the card information embedded in the magnetic strip). Once a credit card number and security code has been skimmed, the skimmer can use such information for purchases until the unauthorized use is detected either by the cardholder or the card issuer.

Losses from skimming have been substantial for certain card industry participants. Although skimming has not had a material impact on the profitability of the Bank, it is possible that such activity could impact this division at some time in the future.

Part of our business depends on sales agents who do not sell our products exclusively.

Our business model, to some degree, depends upon the use of sales agents who are not our employees. These agents sell the products and services of many different processors to merchants and other parties in need of a card services. Failure to maintain good relations with such sales agents could have a negative impact on our business. In addition, new third party relationships have been restricted absent prior approval of OCC. “Business Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Products and services offered by MPS involve many business parties and the possibility of collusion exists.

As described above, the theft of cardholder data is a significant threat in the industry in which MPS operates. This threat also includes the possibility that there is collusion between certain participants in the card system to act illegally. Although MPS is not aware of any instances to date, it is possible that such activities could occur in the future, thereby impacting its operation and profitability.

Competition in the card industry is significant. In order to maintain an edge to its products and offerings, MPS must invest significantly in technology and research and development.

The heavy emphasis upon technology in the products and services offered by MPS requires significant expenditures with respect to research and development both to exploit technological gains and to develop new products and services to meet customers’ needs. As is common with most research and development, while some efforts may yield substantial benefits for the division, others will not, thereby resulting in expenditures for which profits will not be realized. MPS is not able to predict with any degree of certainty as to the level of research and development that will be required in the future, how much those efforts will cost, or how profitable such developments will be for the division once undertaken.

Discover, MasterCard, and Visa, as well as other electronic funds networks in which MPS operates, could change their rules.

Pursuant to the agreements between MPS and Discover, MasterCard, Visa and other card networks, these third parties typically have retained the right to prescribe certain business practices and procedures with respect to parties such as MPS. Such prescribed terms include, but are not limited to, a contracting party’s level of capital as well as other business requirements.

Discover, MasterCard, and Visa also retain the right in their agreements with industry participants such as MPS to unilaterally change the rules under which such transactions are processed with little or no advance warning. This power includes the power to prevent MPS from accessing their networks in order to process transactions. Should any third party choose to invoke this right unilaterally, such changes could materially impact the operations of MPS.

 
60


Our business is heavily dependent upon the Internet and any negative disruptions to its operation could negatively impact our business.

Much of our business depends upon transactions being processed through the Internet. Like nearly all other commercial enterprises, we rely upon others to provide the Internet so that commerce can be conducted. Were there to be a failure in the operation of the Internet or a significant impairment in our ability to move information on the Internet or our ability to do so in accordance with customer safeguard protocols, MPS would develop alternative processes during which time revenues and profitability may be lower.

Our ability to process transactions requires functioning communication and electricity lines.

The nature of the credit card and debit card industry is that it must be operational every day of the week every hour of the week. Any disruption in the utilities utilized by MPS could have a negative effect on our operations and extensive disruptions could materially affect our operations.

Data encryption technology has not been perfected and vigilance in MPS’ information technology systems is costly.

MPS holds sensitive business and personal information with respect to the products and services it offers. This information, which is generally digitally encrypted, is passed along various technology channels, including the Internet. Although MPS encrypts its customer and other sensitive information and expends significant financial and personnel resources to maintain the integrity of its technology networks and the confidentiality of nonpublic customer information, because such information may travel on public technology and other non-secure channels, the confidential information is potentially susceptible to hacking and other illegal intrusions. Were such a security breach to occur, the provision of products and services to customers of MPS would be impaired. In addition, we could incur significant fines from the electronic funds associations involved, or from federal and/or state regulators, and be subject to other prohibitions, as well as extensive litigation from commercial parties and consumers affected by such breach.

Unclaimed funds represented by unused value on the cards presents compliance and other risks.

The notion of escheatment involves property that is abandoned and its rightful owner cannot be readily located and/or identified. In the context of prepaid cards, the funds represented on such cards can sometimes be “abandoned” or unused for the relevant period of time set forth in each applicable state’s abandoned property laws. Although MPS utilizes automated programs to ensure its operations are compliant with such applicable laws and regulations, there appears to be a movement among some state regulators to interpret definitions in those statutes and regulations in a manner that is different from standard industry interpretations. Should such state regulators choose to do so, they may initiate enforcement or other litigation action against prepaid card issuers such as MPS.

MPS operates in a highly competitive environment and the ability to attract and retain qualified personnel may be difficult.

MPS competes in a highly competitive environment with other larger and better capitalized financial intermediaries. In addition, the field of professionals involved in the design and production of products and services offered by MPS is highly skilled and actively sought after by financial institutions, electronic card networks and other commercial entities. As such, MPS must spend significant sums to attract employees and executives and must monitor compensation and other employment trends to ensure that compensation packages both foster the necessary creative environment and appropriately compensate such individuals in order to retain them.

 
61


MPS Revenue Concentration.

MPS works with a large number of business partners to derive its revenue. The Company believes three of its partners have reached a size that, should these partners’ business with the Company end, the earnings attributable to them would have a material effect on the financial results of the Company.

Unresolved Staff Comments

Not Applicable.

Properties

The Company conducts its business at its main office and branch office in Storm Lake, Iowa. The Company operates six offices in metro Des Moines, Iowa. The Company also operates one office in Brookings, South Dakota and three offices in Sioux Falls, South Dakota. In addition, the Company has space at another facility in Sioux Falls, South Dakota, which houses general corporate and MPS functions, in Omaha, Nebraska, which houses certain MPS functions and a non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee.

The Company owns all of its offices, except for the branch offices located in Storm Lake Plaza, Storm Lake, Iowa, on Westown Parkway, West Des Moines, Iowa, on South Western Avenue, Sioux Falls, South Dakota, on West 12th Street, Sioux Falls, South Dakota, the administrative and MPS offices located on Broadband Lane in Sioux Falls, Omaha and the non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee. In regard to the South Western and West 12th Street locations in Sioux Falls, South Dakota, the land on which the buildings were constructed is leased. The total net book value of the Company’s premises and equipment (including land, building and leasehold improvements and furniture, fixtures and equipment) at September 30, 2011 was $17.2 million. See Note 6 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company has experienced rapid growth, particularly as a result of growth of MPS. Management believes current facilities are adequate to meet its present needs.

The Bank maintains an on-line data base with a service bureau, whose primary business is providing such services to financial institutions. The net book value of the data processing and computer equipment utilized by the Company at September 30, 2011 was approximately $2.2 million.

Legal Proceedings

Lawsuits against MetaBank involving the sale of purported MetaBank certificates of deposit continue to be addressed. In all, nine cases have been filed to date, and of those nine, three have been dismissed, and five have been settled for payments that the Company deemed reasonable under the circumstances, including the costs of litigation. Most recently, the class action, Guardian Angel Credit Union v. MetaBank et al., Case No. 08-cv-261-PB (USDC, District of NH), was settled.

There is now one remaining lawsuit relating to this matter: Airline Pilots Assoc Federal Credit Union v. MetaBank, filed in the Iowa District court for Polk County, Case No. CL-118792. The underlying matter was first disclosed in the Company's quarterly report for the period ended December 31, 2007, which stated that an employee of the Bank had sold fraudulent CDs for her own benefit. The unauthorized and illegal actions of the employee have since prompted a number of demands and lawsuits seeking recovery on the fraudulent CDs to be filed against the Bank, which have been disclosed in subsequent filings. The employee was prosecuted, convicted and, on June 2, 2010, sentenced to more than seven years in federal prison and ordered to pay more than $4 million in restitution. Notwithstanding the nature of her crimes, which were unknown by the Bank and its management, plaintiff in the remaining case seeks to impose liability on the Bank under a number of legal theories with respect to the $99,000 fraudulent CD that was issued by the former employee. The Bank and its insurer, which has assumed defense of the action and which is advancing defense costs subject to a reservation of rights, continue to vigorously contest liability in the remaining actions.

 
62


Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust Company v MetaBank, Case No. LACV007196. In a separate matter, on November 3, 2009, Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust Company ("CRBT") filed a Petition against MetaBank in the Iowa District Court in and for Linn County claiming an unspecified amount of money damages against MetaBank arising from CRBT's participation in loans originated by MetaBank to companies owned or controlled by Dan Nelson. The complaint states that the Nelson companies eventually filed for bankruptcy and the loans, including CRBT's portion, were not fully repaid. Under a variety of theories, CRBT claims that MetaBank had material negative information about Dan Nelson, his companies and the loans that it did not share with CRBT prior to CRBT taking a participation interest. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, this matter was settled for a payment deemed reasonable under the circumstances, including costs of litigation.
 
In re Meta Financial Group, Inc., Securities Litigation; Case No. C10-4108MWB. Two former stockholders filed separate purported class action lawsuits against the Company and certain of its officers alleging violations of certain federal securities laws. The cases were filed on October 22, 2010 and November 5, 2010 in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Iowa purportedly on behalf of those who purchased the Company's stock between May 14, 2009 and October 15, 2010. On January 12, 2011, Judge Mark W. Bennett appointed The Eden Partnership lead plaintiff and on March 14, 2011 Eden Partnership filed its amended complaint. The amended complaint alleges that the named officers violated Sections 10(b) and 20(a) of the Securities Exchange Act and SEC Rule 10b-5 in connection with certain allegedly false and misleading public statements made between May 14, 2009 and October 15, 2010 by the Company and its officers. Defendants moved to dismiss the amended complaint in its entirety but on July 18, 2011, the court denied the motion and ordered that discovery proceed. The parties conducted a mediation on December 5, 2011 and reached a tentative settlement of the matter. After the terms of the settlement are reduced to a definitive settlement agreement, the settlement must then be reviewed by the court, submitted to the class members for their consideration and comment, and finally approved by the court before the matter can be dismissed with prejudice. As of the filing of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, provided that the amount of the tentative settlement is approved by the court and the amount of the settlement is paid by the Company's insurance as expected by the Company, the Company does not expect to incur losses in addition to the amounts that it has previously expensed which would be material to its consolidated financial statements.
 
On December 9, 2011, a stockholder derivative complaint captioned Brown v. Haahr, et al., CL 123931, was filed in the Iowa District Court for Polk County against certain officers and directors of the Company. The suit alleges that named parties breached their fiduciary duties to the Company by, among other things, making statements between May, 2009 and October, 2010, which plaintiff claims were false and misleading and by allegedly failing to implement adequate internal controls and means of supervision at the Company. The individual defendants intend to vigorously defend the suit. An estimate of a range of possible loss cannot be made as of the filing of this Annual Report on Form 10-K because of the early stage of the litigation.

In addition to the previously disclosed ATM lawsuits filed in 2011, there were two lawsuits filed in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, and four additional lawsuits since, concerning ATMs sponsored by MetaBank, each involving claims that a notification required to be placed upon an automated teller machine was absent on a specific date, in violation of Regulation E of the Electronic Fund Transfer Act: Wallace Stilz, III. v. Meta Financial Group, Inc., Case No. 1:11-cv-04531, filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois, Eastern Division; and Spencer Webb, Individually and on Behalf of all Others Similarly Situated v. MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02178-H-NLS, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; Tamara Vance, on behalf of herself and a class v. MetaBank, N.A. and Does 1-5, Case No. 1:11-cv-06972, filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois, Eastern Division; Ian Collins, Individually and on Behalf of All Others Similarly Situated v. Mission Gorge Liquor, MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02345-L-POR, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; Spencer Webb, Individually and on Behalf of all Others Similarly Situated v. MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, Swipe USA, LLC, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02240-MMA-BLM, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; and Matthew Johns v. MAF Systems ATM, MetaBank, ATM Express Inc., Does 1-10 and XYZ Corporation, Case No. 2011-25436, filed in the Court of Common Pleas, Montgomery County, Pennsylvania. The Company denies liability in these matters, and will contest these lawsuits with the ATM operators, which are each obligated to indemnify the Company for losses, costs and expenses in these matters. An estimate of a range of possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because the extent of the Company’s indemnification by the ATM operators is unknown.

 
63


Patrick Finn and Light House Management Group, Inc. as Receiver for First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnson v. MetaBank et al, Case 5:11-cv-04041. On May 4, 2011, Patrick Finn and Light House Management Group, Inc. as Receivers for First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnson (“Receivers”) filed a complaint against MetaBank in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Iowa requesting judgment avoiding approximately $1.5 million of transfers that allegedly resulted in a profit to MetaBank arising from MetaBank’s participation in loans originated by First United Funding, LLC. Similar complaints have been filed by the Receivers against other lenders who purchased participation interests in the same or similar loans originated by First United Funding, LLC. The complaint states that First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnston were involved in a criminal enterprise to defraud creditors. Under a variety of theories, Receivers claim that loan repayments to MetaBank constitute fraudulent transfers and MetaBank was unjustly enriched to the detriment of these creditors. MetaBank intends to vigorously defend the case. An estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.5 million as of the filing date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Bank utilizes various third parties for, among other things, its processing needs, both with respect to standard Bank operations and with respect to its MPS division. MPS was notified in April 2008 by one of the processors that the processor's computer system had been breached, which led to the unauthorized load and spending of funds from Bank-issued cards. The Bank believes the amount in question to be approximately $2.0 million. The processor and program manager both have agreements with the Bank to indemnify it for any losses as a result of such unauthorized activity, and the matter is reflected as such in its financial statements. In addition, the Bank has given notice to its own insurer. The Bank has been notified by the processor that its insurer has denied the claim filed. The Bank made demand for payment and filed a demand for arbitration to recover the unauthorized loading and spending amounts and certain damages. The Bank has settled its claim with the program manager, and has received an arbitration award against the processor. That arbitration has been entered as a judgment in the State of South Dakota, which judgment has been transferred to the State of Florida for garnishment proceedings against the processor and its insurer. The Company’s estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.5 million as of the filing date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Certain corporate clients of an unrelated company named Springbok Services, Inc. (“Springbok”) requested through counsel a mediation as a means of reaching a settlement in lieu of commencing litigation against MetaBank. The results of that mediation have not led to a settlement. These claimants purchased MetaBank prepaid reward cards from Springbok, prior to Springbok’s bankruptcy. As a result of Springbok’s bankruptcy and cessation of business, some of the rewards cards which had been purchased were never activated or funded. Counsel for these companies have indicated that they are prepared to assert claims totaling approximately $1.5 million against MetaBank based on principal/agency or failure to supervise theories. The Company denies liability with respect to these claims. The Company’s estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.3 million.

See Item 1 “Business – Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters for a discussion of the settlement of OTS enforcement matters and on-going compliance matters.

Other than the matters set forth above, there are no other new material pending legal proceedings or updates to which the Company or its subsidiaries is a party other than ordinary litigation routine to their respective businesses.

Removed and Reserved

 
64


PART II

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Securities

The Company’s common stock trades on the NASDAQ Global Market® under the symbol “CASH.” Quarterly dividends for 2011 and 2010 were $0.13. The price range of the common stock, as reported on the NASDAQ Global Market, was as follows:

   
Fiscal Year 2011
   
Fiscal Year 2010
 
   
Low
   
High
   
Low
   
High
 
                         
First Quarter
  $ 12.63     $ 33.23     $ 20.45     $ 23.76  
Second Quarter
    13.85       18.50       17.40       25.25  
Third Quarter
    13.22       19.05       24.97       32.67  
Fourth Quarter
    17.14       22.30       29.28       36.72  

Prices disclose inter-dealer quotations without retail mark-up, mark-down or commissions, and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.

Dividend payment decisions are made with consideration of a variety of factors including earnings, financial condition, market considerations, and regulatory restrictions.

As of September 30, 2011, the Company had 3,146,867 shares of common stock outstanding, which were held by approximately 200 stockholders of record, and 485,352 shares subject to outstanding options. The stockholders of record number does not reflect approximately 800 persons or entities that hold their stock in nominee or “street” name.

The transfer agent for the Company’s common stock is Registrar & Transfer Company, 10 Commerce Drive, Cranford, New Jersey, 07016.

There have been no purchases by the Company during the quarter ended September 30, 2011 of equity securities that are registered by the Company pursuant to Section 12 of the Exchange Act.

 
65


Selected Financial Data

SEPTEMBER 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
                               
SELECTED FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA
                             
(Dollars in Thousands)
                             
                               
Total assets
  $ 1,275,481     $ 1,029,766     $ 834,777     $ 710,236     $ 686,080  
Loans receivable, net
    314,410       366,045       391,609       427,928       355,612  
Securities available for sale
    619,248       506,852       364,838       203,834       158,701  
Goodwill and intangible assets
    1,315       2,663       2,215       2,206       1,508  
Deposits
    1,141,620       897,454       653,747       499,804       522,978  
Total borrowings
    29,365       41,214       116,796       147,683       78,534  
Shareholders' equity
    80,577       72,044       47,345       45,733       48,098  
                                         
                                         
YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
    2011       2010       2009       2008       2007  
                                         
SELECTED OPERATIONS DATA
                                       
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
                                       
                                         
Total interest income
  $ 39,059     $ 39,083     $ 36,726     $ 37,418     $ 37,774  
Total interest expense
    4,747       5,993       8,907       13,415       16,967  
Net interest income
    34,312       33,090       27,819       24,003       20,807  
Provision for loan losses
    278       15,791       18,713       2,715       3,168  
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
    34,034       17,299       9,106       21,288       17,639  
Total non-interest income
    57,491       97,444       79,969       37,696       21,858  
Total non-interest expense
    83,262       94,930       91,081       61,820       36,958  
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income tax expense (benefit)
    8,263       19,813       (2,006 )     (2,836 )     2,539  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    3,623       7,420       (543 )     (1,002 )     1,227  
Income (loss) from continuing operations
    4,640       12,393       (1,463 )     (1,834 )     1,312  
Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
    -       -       -       811       (141 )
Net income (loss)
    4,640       12,393       (1,463 )     (1,023 )     1,171  
                                         
                                         
Basic earnings (loss) per common share:
                                       
Income (loss) from continuing operations
  $ 1.49     $ 4.23     $ (0.56 )   $ (0.71 )   $ 0.52  
Income (loss) from discontinued operations
    -       -       -       0.31       (0.06 )
Net income (loss)
  $ 1.49     $ 4.23     $ (0.56 )   $ (0.40 )   $ 0.46  
                                         
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share:
                                       
Income (loss) from continuing operations
  $ 1.49     $ 4.11     $ (0.56 )   $ (0.69 )   $ 0.50  
Income (loss) from discontinued operations
    -       -       -       0.31       (0.05 )
Net income (loss)
  $ 1.49     $ 4.11     $ (0.56 )   $ (0.38 )   $ 0.45  

 
66


YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
                               
SELECTED FINANCIAL RATIOS AND OTHER DATA
                             
                               
PERFORMANCE RATIOS
                             
Return on average assets
    0.41 %     1.22 %     -0.20 %     -0.14 %     -0.14 %
Return on average assets-continuing operations
    0.41 %     1.22 %     -0.20 %     -0.24 %     -0.24 %
Return on average equity
    5.71 %     20.59 %     -3.13 %     -2.27 %     2.69 %
Return on average equity-continuing operations
    5.71 %     20.59 %     -3.13 %     -4.07 %     3.01 %
Net interest margin-continuing operations
    3.21 %     3.43 %     3.50 %     3.51 %     3.38 %
Operating expense to average assets-continuing operations
    7.33 %     9.36 %     10.55 %     8.25 %     5.26 %
                                         
QUALITY RATIOS-Continuing Operations
                                       
Non-performing assets to total assets at end of year
    1.24 %     0.94 %     1.76 %     1.06 %     0.38 %
Allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans
    53 %     63 %     55 %     76 %     196 %
                                         
CAPITAL RATIOS
                                       
Shareholders' equity to total assets at end of period
    6.32 %     7.00 %     5.67 %     6.44 %     7.01 %
Average shareholders' equity to average assets
    7.16 %     5.93 %     5.42 %     6.01 %     6.20 %
                                         
OTHER DATA
                                       
Book value per common share outstanding
  $ 25.61     $ 23.15     $ 17.97     $ 17.58     $ 18.57  
Dividends declared per share
    0.52       0.52       0.52       0.52       0.52  
Number of full-service offices
    12       12       12       13       17  
                                         
                                         
Common Shares Outstanding
    3,146,867       3,111,413       2,634,215       2,601,103       2,589,717  

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

This section should be read in conjunction with the following parts on this Form 10-K: Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” Part II, Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk,” and Part I, Item 1 “Business.”

General

The Company is a unitary savings and loan holding company whose primary subsidiary is the Bank. The Company focuses on two core businesses, its regional Retail Banking business and a national payments business, conducted through its MPS division. The Company’s Retail Bank business is focused on establishing and maintaining long-term relationships with customers, and is committed to serving the financial service needs of the communities in its market area. The Retail Bank’s primary market area includes the following counties: Buena Vista, Dallas and Polk located in central and northwestern Iowa, and Brookings, Lincoln, and Minnehaha located in east central South Dakota. The Retail Bank segment attracts retail deposits from the general public and uses those deposits, together with other borrowed funds, to originate and purchase residential and commercial mortgage loans, and to originate consumer, agricultural and other commercial loans and to purchase various investment and mortgage-backed securities.

MPS, a division of the Bank, is an industry leader in the issuance of prepaid debit cards and is also a provider of a wide range of payment-related products and services, including prepaid debit cards such as those related to gift, tax refunds, rebate, travel and payroll, ATMs, and consumer credit products. MPS pursues a strategy of working with industry-leading companies in a variety of businesses to help them introduce new payment products to their customers. In addition, MPS partners with emerging companies to develop and introduce new payment products. MPS earns revenues from fees and is responsible for the bulk of our low- and no-cost demand deposits related to its prepaid card business. Certain MPS’ activities have been significantly curtailed as a result of Consent Orders issued by the OTS, our former regulator. For a description of the Consent Orders, see Item 1 “Business – Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation.” The Consent Orders, and the related directives that preceded them, have had a significant impact on revenues, profitability, and growth of the MPS division, the Bank, and the Company as a whole.

 
67


Overview of Corporate Developments

The most significant financial developments occurred in the Bank’s MPS division. MPS’ fiscal 2011 net income was $3.9 million compared to net income of $12.6 million in fiscal 2010. While non-interest income decreased by $39.6 million in fiscal 2011, noninterest expenses decreased by $15.2 million and loan loss provision expense declined by $11.8 million primarily due to the discontinuance of iAdvance in October 2010 and certain income tax-related programs previously disclosed in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended September 30, 2010. The remainder of the decrease relates to the $5.2 million of charges resolving previously disclosed actions of the OTS which were recorded in fiscal 2011. For additional discussion, see Item 1, “Business – Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation.”

As mentioned earlier in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, on July 15, 2011, the Company and the Bank each stipulated and consented to a Cease and Desist Order (the "Orders" or the “Consent Orders”) issued by the OTS. Since the issuance of the Supervisory Directives, during the last calendar quarter of 2010, the Company and the Bank have been cooperating with the regulatory authorities to correct those aspects of our operations that were addressed in the Consent Orders. Based on an interim examination by our previous regulator, the OTS, we believe we have already made substantial progress. The Company and MetaBank have completed many of the items in the Orders and expect to complete substantially all of the required actions in the Orders by their respective deadline dates. Notwithstanding our belief as to substantial progress, we are currently undergoing an examination by our new regulator, the OCC, and we can provide no assurances as to whether the OCC will concur with our belief on what actions will be taken by the OCC if it does not so concur. See Item 1A “Risk Factors – Risks Related To Our Industry and Business.” See Item 1 “Business – Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”

The Retail Bank segment is continuing to build its customer base from its previous expansion in the growing metropolitan areas of Sioux Falls, South Dakota and Des Moines, Iowa. The Bank focuses primarily on establishing lending and deposit relationships with commercial businesses and commercial real estate owners or developers in these communities. The Company is now a unitary savings and loan holding company, not a bank holding company, and is subject to the jurisdiction of the Federal Reserve. The Bank operates 12 Retail Banking branches: in Brookings (1) and Sioux Falls (3), South Dakota, in Des Moines (6) and Storm Lake (2), Iowa and maintains a non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee. During fiscal 2011, the Retail Bank segment recognized a goodwill impairment charge of $1.5 million due primarily to the decline in stock price of the Company during the first fiscal quarter of 2011. The original goodwill asset represented the excess of acquisition costs over the fair value of the net assets acquired in an earlier bank acquisition.

Effective as of September 30, 2011, James S. Haahr retired as Chairman of the board of directors of the Company and the Bank, succeeded as Chairman by J. Tyler Haahr who continued as President & CEO of the Company and the Bank. In addition, effective as of October 1, 2011, E. Thurman Gaskill, a Company board member since 1982, was named to the newly created position of Vice-Chairman and Lead Director of the board of directors of the Company and the Bank. Troy Moore III, Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer, was named to the board of directors of the Company and the Bank effective as of October 1, 2011.

Financial Condition

The following discussion of the Company's consolidated financial condition should be read in conjunction with the Selected Consolidated Financial Information and Consolidated Financial Statements and the related notes included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

As of September 30, 2011, the Company’s assets grew by $245.7 million, or 24.0%, to $1.3 billion compared to $1.0 billion at September 30, 2010. The increase in assets was reflected primarily in increases in the Company’s mortgage-backed securities and to a lesser extent the Company’s cash and cash equivalents, offset in part by smaller decreases in the Company’s portfolio of net loans.

 
68


Total cash and cash equivalents and federal funds sold were $276.9 million at September 30, 2011, an increase of $189.4 million from $87.5 million at September 30, 2010. The growth primarily was the result of the Company’s increased liquidity from an increase in deposits, primarily due to low- and no-cost deposits generated by the MPS division. In general, the Company maintains its cash investments in interest-bearing overnight deposits with the Federal Home Loan Bank, (“FHLB”) and the Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”). Federal funds sold deposits may be maintained at the FHLB. At September 30, 2011 the Company had no federal funds sold.

The total of mortgage-backed securities and investment securities available for sale increased $112.4 million, or 22.2%, to $619.2 million at September 30, 2011, as investment purchases exceeded related maturities, sales, and principal pay downs. The Company’s portfolio of investment securities available for sale consists primarily of mortgage-backed securities, which have relatively short expected lives. During fiscal 2011, the Company purchased $281.7 million of mortgage-backed securities with average lives of five years or less or stated final maturities of approximately 30 years or less and sold mortgage-backed securities in the amount of $54.8 million. In addition, the Company purchased $8.3 million of investment securities which are comprised of corporate and tax exempt bonds. See Note 3 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which are included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company's portfolio of net loans receivable decreased by $51.6 million, or 14.1%, to $314.4 million at September 30, 2011 from $366.0 million at September 30, 2010. All loan categories decreased due to broadly lower demand in the Company’s markets, a reduction in purchased loans, and increased repayment and prepayment speeds given the lower interest rate environment. See Note 4 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company owns stock in the FHLB due to its membership and participation in this banking system. The Company’s investment in such stock decreased $0.6 million, or 10.3%, to $4.7 million at September 30, 2011 from $5.3 million at September 30, 2010. The decrease was due to a decrease in the level of borrowings from the FHLB, which require a calculated level of stock investment based on a formula determined by the FHLB.

Insurance receivable decreased $1.4 million at September 30, 2011 to $2.3 million from $3.7 million at September 30, 2010 as management revised the expected receipt of insurance proceeds related to the purported MetaBank certificate of deposits matter disclosed in Item 3. “Legal Proceedings.”

Premises, furniture, and equipment decreased $2.2 million to $17.2 million at September 30, 2011 from $19.4 million at September 30, 2010 due to depreciation exceeding purchases.

Foreclosed real estate and repossessed assets increased to $2.7 million as compared to $1.3 million at September 30, 2010 due to the foreclosure of assets and loan collateral related to previously reported non-performing loans exceeding sales and write offs.

Goodwill and intangible assets decreased $1.3 million, or 50.6%, to $1.3 million at September 30, 2011. Based upon the Company’s periodic goodwill impairment testing, it was determined that the Retail Bank goodwill was impaired. The Company wrote-off the entire amount of $1.5 million during the first quarter of fiscal 2011 due primarily to the decline in stock price of the Company at that time.

Total deposits increased by $244.2 million, or 27.2%, to $1.1 billion at September 30, 2011 from $897.4 million at September 30, 2010. During fiscal 2011, the Company continued to grow its low- and no-cost deposit portfolio. Deposits attributable to MPS were up $270.0 million, or 41.2%, at September 30, 2011, as compared to September 30, 2010. This increase results from growth in existing prepaid card programs. As mentioned previously, it is unclear what the level of MPS-generated deposits will be in fiscal 2012.

The Company’s total borrowings decreased $11.8 million, or 28.8%, from $41.2 million at September 30, 2010 to $29.4 million at September 30, 2011, primarily due to the growth of deposits. See Notes 8, 9, and 10 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 
69


At September 30, 2011, the Company’s stockholders’ equity totaled $80.6 million, up $8.6 million from $72.0 million at September 30, 2010. The increase was related to a favorable change in the accumulated other comprehensive loss on the Company’s available for sale portfolio and offset, in part, by the payment of cash dividends on the Company’s common stock. At September 30, 2011, the Bank continues to meet regulatory requirements for classification as a well-capitalized institution. See Note 14 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Results of Operations

The following discussion of the Company's Results of Operations should be read in conjunction with the Selected Consolidated Financial Information and Consolidated Financial Statements and the related notes included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company's Results of Operations are dependent on net interest income, provision for loan losses, non-interest income, non-interest expense, and income tax expense. Net interest income is the difference, or spread, between the average yield on interest-earning assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. The interest rate spread is affected by regulatory, economic, and competitive factors that influence interest rates, loan demand, and deposit flows. Notwithstanding that a significant amount of the Company’s deposits pay low rates of interest, the Company, like other financial institutions, is subject to interest rate risk to the extent that its interest-earning assets mature or reprice at different times, or on a different basis, than its interest-bearing liabilities. The Company’s non-interest income decreased in fiscal 2011 as compared to fiscal 2010, and improved significantly in fiscal 2010 as compared to fiscal 2009. Non-interest expense, related primarily to card processing expense, decreased in proportion to non-interest income as compared to the prior fiscal year. A more detailed explanation of the factors responsible for results of operations of the Company is presented below.

The Company's non-interest income is derived primarily from prepaid card, credit products, and ATM fees attributable to MPS and fees charged on bank loans and transaction accounts. This income is offset by expenses, such as compensation and occupancy expenses associated with additional personnel and office locations as well as card processing expenses attributable to MPS. To a lesser extent, non-interest income is derived from gains or losses on the sale of securities available for sale as well as the Company’s holdings of bank owned life insurance. Non-interest expense is also impacted by occupancy and equipment expenses, regulatory expenses, and legal and consulting expenses.

Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended
September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010

General. The Company recorded net income of $4.6 million, or $1.49 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2011 compared to $12.4 million, or $4.11 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2010. The decrease in net income in the current period was primarily caused by a decrease in non-interest income which were partially offset by a reduction in the provision for loan losses and a reduction in non-interest expenses. In addition, net interest income increased $1.2 million as compared to the prior fiscal year.

Net Interest Income. Net interest income for fiscal 2011 increased by $1.2 million, or 3.7%, to $34.3 million from $33.1 million for the prior fiscal year. Net interest margin decreased to 3.21% in fiscal 2011 as compared to 3.43% in fiscal 2010.

The Company’s average earning assets increased $104.4 million, or 10.8%, to $1.1 billion during fiscal 2011 from $964.6 million during fiscal 2010. The increase is primarily the result of the increase in the Company’s mortgage-backed securities portfolio. Overall, asset yields declined by 40 basis points due to lower average rates. The increase in average earning assets was offset by a change in the mix of earning assets, to more investment securities and fewer loans, and a decrease in yields in mortgage-backed securities and other investments. Additionally, the prior fiscal year also included the effect of tax-related loans which were not present after October 13, 2010 in the current fiscal year.

 
70


The Company’s average total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities increased $99.5 million, or 10.6%, to $1.0 billion during fiscal 2011 from $935.3 million during fiscal 2010. The increase resulted mainly from an increase in the Company’s non-interest-bearing deposits. The average outstanding balance of non-interest bearing deposits increased from $633.2 million in fiscal 2010 to $780.9 million in fiscal 2011. The Company’s cost of total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities declined 18 basis points to 0.46% during fiscal 2011 from 0.64% during fiscal 2010 primarily due to continued migration to low and no-cost deposits provided by MPS.

 
71


Average Balances, Interest Rates, and Yields

The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the total dollar amount of interest income from average interest-earning assets and the resulting yields, as well as the interest expense on average interest-bearing liabilities, expressed both in dollars and rates. No tax equivalent adjustments have been made. Non-Accruing loans have been included in the table as loans carrying a zero yield.

Year Ended September 30,
       
2011
               
2010
               
2009
       
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Average
   
Interest
         
Average
   
Interest
         
Average
   
Interest
       
   
Outstanding
   
Earned /
   
Yield /
   
Outstanding
   
Earned /
   
Yield /
   
Outstanding
   
Earned /
   
Yield /
 
   
Balance
   
Paid
   
Rate
   
Balance
   
Paid
   
Rate
   
Balance
   
Paid
   
Rate
 
                                                       
Interest-earning assets:
                                                     
Loans receivable
  $ 338,114     $ 19,654       5.81 %   $ 402,750     $ 24,944       6.19 %   $ 423,915     $ 25,561       6.03 %
Mortgage-backed securities
    549,374       18,362       3.34 %     422,904       13,370       3.16 %     259,265       10,230       3.95 %
Other investments
    181,514       1,043       0.57 %     138,915       769       0.55 %     111,910       935       0.84 %
Total interest-earning assets
    1,069,002     $ 39,059       3.65 %     964,569     $ 39,083       4.05 %     795,090     $ 36,726       4.62 %
Non-interest-earning assets
    67,114                       49,739                       68,187                  
Total assets
  $ 1,136,116                     $ 1,014,308                     $ 863,277                  
                                                                         
Non-interest bearing deposits
  $ 780,941     $ -       0.00 %   $ 633,246     $ -       0.00 %   $ 490,651     $ -       0.00 %
Interest-bearing liabilities:
                                                                       
Interest-bearing checking
    32,717       409       1.25 %     21,169       258       1.22 %     15,795       39       0.25 %
Savings
    11,248       37       0.33 %     10,431       34       0.33 %     9,734       38       0.39 %
Money markets
    34,975       234       0.67 %     34,713       292       0.84 %     38,559       415       1.08 %
Time deposits
    119,318       2,389       2.00 %     136,409       3,324       2.44 %     146,647       4,849       3.31 %
FHLB advances
    39,316       1,181       3.00 %     76,312       1,558       2.04 %     66,272       2,627       3.96 %
Other borrowings
    16,322       497       3.04 %     23,023       527       2.29 %     32,477       939       2.89 %
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    253,896       4,747       1.87 %     302,057       5,993       1.98 %     309,484       8,907       2.88 %
Total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities
    1,034,837     $ 4,747       0.46 %     935,303     $ 5,993       0.64 %     800,135     $ 8,907       1.11 %
Other non-interest bearing liabilities
    19,956                       18,815                       16,383                  
Total liabilities
    1,054,793                       954,118                       816,518                  
Shareholders' equity
    81,323                       60,190                       46,759                  
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
  $ 1,136,116                     $ 1,014,308                     $ 863,277                  
Net interest income and net interest rate spread including non-interest bearing deposits
          $ 34,312       3.19 %           $ 33,090       3.41 %           $ 27,819       3.51 %
                                                                         
Net interest margin
                    3.21 %                     3.43 %                     3.50 %

 
72


Rate / Volume Analysis

The following schedule presents the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for major components of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. It distinguishes between the increase related to higher outstanding balances and that due to the levels and volatility of interest rates. For each category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, information is provided on changes attributable to (i) changes in volume (i.e. changes in volume multiplied by old rate) and (ii) changes in rate (i.e. changes in rate multiplied by old volume). For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume that cannot be segregated have been allocated proportionately to the change due to volume and the change due to rate.

Rate / Volume
                                   
                                     
Year Ended September 30,
 
2011 vs. 2010
   
2010 vs. 2009
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
                                   
   
Increase /
   
Increase /
   
Total
   
Increase /
   
Increase /
   
Total
 
   
(Decrease)
   
(Decrease)
   
Increase /
   
(Decrease)
   
(Decrease)
   
Increase /
 
   
Due to Volume
   
Due to Rate
   
(Decrease)
   
Due to Volume
   
Due to Rate
   
(Decrease)
 
                                     
Interest-earning assets
                                   
Loans receivable
  $ (3,826 )   $ (1,464 )   $ (5,290 )   $ (1,317 )   $ 700     $ (617 )
Mortgage-backed securities
    4,193       799       4,992       4,597       (1,457 )     3,140  
Other investments
    245       29       274       385       (551 )     (166 )
Total interest-earning assets
  $ 612     $ (636 )   $ (24 )   $ 3,665     $ (1,308 )   $ 2,357  
                                                 
Interest-bearing liabilities
                                               
Interest-bearing checking
  $ 144     $ 7     $ 151     $ 18     $ 202     $ 220  
Savings
    3       -       3       3       (7 )     (4 )
Money markets
    2       (60 )     (58 )     (38 )     (85 )     (123 )
Time deposits
    (383 )     (552 )     (935 )     (320 )     (1,205 )     (1,525 )
FHLB advances
    (12,861 )     12,484       (377 )     486       (1,555 )     (1,069 )
Other borrowings
    240       (270 )     (30 )     (241 )     (172 )     (413 )
Total interest-bearing liabilities
  $ (12,855 )   $ 11,609     $ (1,246 )   $ (92 )   $ (2,822 )   $ (2,914 )
                                                 
Net effect on net interest income
  $ 13,467     $ (12,245 )   $ 1,222     $ 3,757     $ 1,514     $ 5,271  

Provision for Loan Losses. In fiscal 2011, the Company recorded a provision for loan losses of $0.3 million, compared to $15.8 million for fiscal 2010. The MPS division had a reduction of $11.8 million when comparing the fiscal 2011 to the fiscal 2010 provision, primarily because the Bank did not offer iAdvance and tax-related loan programs after October 13, 2010. In addition, the Retail Bank had a reduction of $3.7 million when comparing the fiscal 2011 to the fiscal 2010 provision.

Management closely monitors economic developments both regionally and nationwide, and considers these factors when assessing the adequacy of its allowance for loan losses (“ALL”). While the Company has no direct exposure to sub-prime mortgage loans, management believes the current recessionary environment may strain the financial condition of some borrowers. Management therefore believes that future losses in the residential portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. Concerns regarding the economic slowdown, have led management to the conclusion that future losses in its commercial and multi-family and commercial business portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. On the other hand, current trends in agricultural markets remain reasonable. Higher commodity prices as well as average to above average yields created positive economic conditions for most farmers in our markets in 2011. Nonetheless, management still expects that future losses within the agricultural operating portfolio, which have been very low, could be higher than recent historical experience. Management believes that the aforementioned recession may also negatively impact consumers’ repayment capacities. Additionally, a sizable portion of the Company’s consumer loan portfolio is secured by residential real estate, as discussed above, which is an area to be closely monitored by management in view of its stated concerns. Despite our efforts to monitor our credits, we can offer no assurance that loan losses in fiscal 2012 and thereafter will not exceed the relatively low levels of such losses taken in fiscal 2011.

The allowance for loan losses established in connection with MPS operations results from an estimation process that evaluates relevant characteristics of its credit portfolio. We consider other internal and external environmental factors such as changes in operations or personnel and economic events that may affect the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses. Adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are recorded periodically based on the result of this estimation process. Due to the varied and unknown nature and structures of future credit programs, the exact methodology to determine the ALL for each program will not be identical. Each program may have differing levels of risk, definitions of delinquency and loss, inclusion/exclusion of credit bureau criteria, roll rate migration dynamics, etc. Similarly, the additional capital required to offset the increased risk in subprime lending activities may vary by credit program. Each program is evaluated separately and with potentially different methodologies. For example, the increased charge-offs for MPS credit in fiscal 2010 resulted primarily from pre-season tax loans to sub-prime borrowers that peaked in January 2010. Management was pro-active and established a provision for loan losses for these loans during the tax pre-season offering period. The majority of the charge-offs for these pre-season tax loans were recorded against the allowance for loan losses in the third quarter of fiscal 2010. The charge-offs were in accordance with management’s expectations of the pre-season tax program.

 
73


Management believes that, based on a detailed review of the loan portfolio, historic loan losses, current economic conditions, the size of the loan portfolio, and other factors, the current level of the allowance for loan losses at September 30, 2011 reflects an adequate allowance against probable losses from the loan portfolio. Although the Company maintains its allowance for loan losses at a level that it considers to be adequate, investors and others are cautioned that there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods. In addition, the Company's determination of the allowance for loan losses is subject to review by its regulatory agencies, the OCC and the Federal Reserve, which can require the establishment of additional general or specific allowances.

Non-Interest Income. Non-interest income decreased by $39.9 million, or 41.0%, to $57.5 million for fiscal 2011 from $97.4 million for fiscal 2010.

The decline in card fees of $39.3 million in fiscal 2011 as compared to fiscal 2010 was primarily due to the discontinuance of the iAdvance and certain tax-related programs in the MPS segment and the reimbursement of $4.8 million in card fees related to the previously disclosed OTS administrative actions related to the iAdvance program.

 Fees earned on prepaid debit cards, credit products and other payment systems products and services were $53.9 million for fiscal 2011 as compared to $93.2 million for fiscal 2010

In addition, the Bank recorded a gain on sale of securities available for sale of $1.8 million in fiscal 2011 as compared to gain on sale of $2.1 million in the prior fiscal year.

Non-Interest Expense. Non-interest expense decreased by $11.7 million, or 12.3%, to $83.3 million for fiscal 2011 from $94.9 million for the same period in fiscal 2010.

Compensation expense totaled $30.5 million for fiscal 2011 as compared to $32.5 million for fiscal 2010. Overall staffing is 6% lower than at September 30, 2010.

The reduction was primarily attributable to a reduction in card processing expense, which declined $14.9 million from $38.2 million in fiscal 2010 to $23.3 million in fiscal 2011 due to the discontinuance of the iAdvance and tax-related programs that were previously disclosed above. These expenses primarily stem from prepaid card and credit-related programs managed by MPS. Other card processing expense increases are attributable to settlement functions for value loading, card sales and anticipated growth of existing products.

The Company’s occupancy and equipment expense totaled $8.5 million for fiscal 2011 as compared to $8.2 million for fiscal 2010. The increase was due to supporting existing product lines and increasing market penetration of MPS products and services.

Goodwill impairment expense was recorded for the fiscal 2011of $1.5 million due to the Retail Bank segment’s write off of goodwill due to impairment related primarily to the recent decline in stock price of the Company in the quarter ended December 31, 2010.

 
74


On December 9, 2010, the Bank discovered that two wire transfers in the amount of approximately $1.1 million had been fraudulently initiated several days before through identify theft. The Bank recorded a loss of $0.6 million at December 31, 2010. After investigation, in March 2011, the Bank established an insurance receivable of $0.5 million for the balance of the fraud.

During the third quarter of fiscal 2011, the Company recorded as card processing expense a civil money penalty of $0.4 million as part of the overall OTS-related settlement of administrative actions.

The Company incurred higher legal and consulting expenses of $1.7 million in fiscal 2011 as compared to fiscal 2010 related primarily to regulatory matters.

The Company settled the Guardian Angel Credit Union v MetaBank lawsuit which resulted in an increase in other noninterest expense in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 of $1.6 million as compared to no expense in fiscal 2010.

Income Tax Expense. Income tax expense for fiscal 2011 was $3.6 million, or an effective tax rate of 43.8%, compared to a tax expense of $7.4 million, or an effective tax rate of 37.4%, in fiscal 2010. The change in tax expense is primarily due to the change in net income before income tax expense. The Company’s recorded income tax expense was also impacted primarily by permanent differences between book and taxable income. The Company’s recorded income tax expense and the effective tax rate was impacted by permanent differences between book and taxable income primarily related to the write off of goodwill of $1.5 million and the assessment of $0.4 million. The nature and timing of the items discussed above resulted in a higher effective tax rate for fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010.

Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended
September 30, 2010 and September 30, 2009

General. The Company recorded net income of $12.4 million, or $4.11 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2010 compared to a loss of $1.5 million, or $0.56 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2009. The increase in net income in the current period was primarily caused by an increase in non-interest income and a reduction in the provision for loan losses which were partially offset by an increase in non-interest expense. In addition, net interest income increased $5.3 million as compared to the prior fiscal year.

Net Interest Income. Net interest income for fiscal 2010 increased by $5.3 million, or 18.9%, to $33.1 million from $27.8 million for the prior fiscal year. Net interest margin decreased slightly to 3.43% in fiscal year 2010 as compared to 3.50% in fiscal year 2009.

The Company’s average earning assets increased $169.5 million, or 21.3%, to $964.6 million during fiscal year 2010 from $795.1 million during fiscal year 2009. The increase is primarily the result of the increase in the Company’s mortgage-backed securities portfolio. Overall, asset yields declined by 57 basis points due to lower average rates. The increase in average earning assets was offset by a change in the mix of earning assets, to more investment securities and fewer loans, and a decrease in yields in mortgage-backed securities and other investments.

The Company’s average total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities increased $135.2 million, or 16.9%, to $935.3 million during fiscal year 2010 from $800.1 million during fiscal year 2009. The increase resulted mainly from an increase in the Company’s non-interest-bearing deposits. The Company’s cost of total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities declined 47 basis points to 0.64% during fiscal year 2010 from 1.11% during fiscal year 2009 primarily due to continued migration to low and no-cost deposits provided by MPS.

Provision for Loan Losses. In fiscal 2010, the Company recorded a provision for loan losses of $15.8 million, compared to $18.7 million for fiscal 2009. $11.4 million of the fiscal 2010 provision related to MPS, of which $9.9 million relates to the completion of a loan program offered in collaboration with MPS’s tax preparation partner with all appropriate accounts now charged-off, consistent with our policy. There are no loan balances or allowance remaining for this program as of September 30, 2010.


Management closely monitors economic developments both regionally and nationwide, and considers these factors when assessing the adequacy of its allowance for loan losses. While the Company has no direct exposure to sub-prime mortgage loans, management believes the current recessionary environment may strain the financial condition of some borrowers. Management therefore believes that future losses in the residential portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. Concerns regarding the economic slowdown, have led management to the conclusion that future losses in its commercial and multi-family and commercial business portfolio may be somewhat higher than historical experience. On the other hand, current trends in agricultural markets remain reasonable. Higher commodity prices as well as average to above average yields created positive economic conditions for most farmers in our markets in 2009. Nonetheless, management still expects that future losses in this portfolio, which have been very low, could be higher than recent historical experience. Management believes that the aforementioned recession may also negatively impact consumers’ repayment capacities. Additionally, a sizable portion of the Company’s consumer loan portfolio is secured by residential real estate, as discussed above, which is an area to be closely monitored by management in view of its stated concerns.

The allowance for loan losses established in connection with MPS operations results from an estimation process that evaluates relevant characteristics of its credit portfolio(s). MPS considers other internal and external environmental factors such as changes in operations or personnel and economic events that may affect the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses. Adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are recorded periodically based on the result of this estimation process. Due to the varied and unknown nature and structures of future credit programs, the exact methodology to determine the ALL for each program will not be identical. Each program may have differing levels of risk, definitions of delinquency and loss, inclusion/exclusion of credit bureau criteria, roll rate migration dynamics, etc. Similarly, the additional capital required to offset the increased risk in subprime lending activities may vary by credit program. Each program will need to be evaluated separately and with potentially different methodologies. The increased charge-offs for MPS credit resulted primarily from pre-season tax loans to sub-prime borrowers that peaked in January 2010. Management was pro-active and established a provision for loan losses for these loans during the tax pre-season offering period. The majority of the charge-offs for these pre-season tax loans were recorded against the allowance for loan losses in the third quarter of fiscal 2010. The charge-offs were in accordance with management’s expectations of the pre-season tax program.

Management believes that, based on a detailed review of the loan portfolio, historic loan losses, current economic conditions, the size of the loan portfolio, and other factors, the current level of the allowance for loan losses at September 30, 2010 reflects an adequate allowance against probable losses from the loan portfolio. Although the Company maintains its allowance for loan losses at a level that it considers to be adequate, investors and others are cautioned that there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods. In addition, the Company's determination of the allowance for loan losses is subject to review by its regulatory agencies, which can require the establishment of additional general or specific allowances.

Non-Interest Income. Non-interest income increased by $17.4 million, or 21.9%, to $97.4 million for fiscal 2010 from $80.0 million for fiscal 2009. Fees earned on prepaid debit cards, credit products and other payment systems products and services were $93.2 million for fiscal 2010 as compared to $77.5 million for fiscal 2009.

In addition, the Bank recorded a gain on sale of securities available for sale of $2.1 million in fiscal 2010 as compared to gain on sale of $0.8 million in the prior fiscal year.

Non-Interest Expense. Non-interest expense increased by $3.8 million, or 4.2%, to $94.9 million for fiscal 2010 from $91.1 million for the same period in fiscal year 2009.

Compensation expense totaled $32.5 million for fiscal 2010 as compared to $32.7 million for fiscal 2009. In January 2010, the Company eliminated 47 positions in MPS. The reduction in compensation expense is expected to amount to nearly $5.0 million, on an annualized basis, as a result of this action.

Costs associated with the operational support of card-related products at MPS also increased. Card processing expenses totaled $38.2 million for fiscal 2010 as compared to $33.5 million for fiscal 2009. These expenses primarily stem from prepaid card and credit-related programs managed by MPS. Other card processing expense increases are attributable to settlement functions for value loading and card sales.


The Company’s occupancy and equipment expense totaled $8.2 million for fiscal 2010 as compared to $8.0 million for fiscal 2009. The increase was due to supporting new product lines and increasing market penetration of MPS products and services.

Income Tax Expense (Benefit). Income tax expense for fiscal 2010 was $7.4 million, or an effective tax rate of 37.4%, compared to a tax benefit of $0.5 million, or an effective tax rate of 27.1%, in fiscal 2009. The change in tax expense is primarily due to the change in net income before income tax expense. The Company’s recorded income tax expense was also impacted primarily by permanent differences between book and taxable income.

Critical Accounting Policies

The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with GAAP. The financial information contained within these statements is, to a significant extent, financial information that is based on approximate measures of the financial effects of transactions and events that have already occurred. Based on its consideration of accounting policies that: (i) involve the most complex and subjective decisions and assessments which may be uncertain at the time the estimate was made, and (ii) different estimates that reasonably could have been used in the current period, or changes in the accounting estimate that are reasonably likely to occur from period to period, would have a material impact on the financial statements, management has identified the policies described below as Critical Accounting Policies. This discussion should be read in conjunction with the Company’s financial statements and the accompanying notes presented in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” contained herein.

Allowance for Loan Losses. The Company’s allowance for loan loss methodology incorporates a variety of risk considerations, both quantitative and qualitative, in establishing an allowance for loan loss that management believes is appropriate at each reporting date. Quantitative factors include the Company’s historical loss experience, delinquency and charge-off trends, collateral values, changes in nonperforming loans, and other factors. Quantitative factors also incorporate known information about individual loans, including borrowers’ sensitivity to interest rate movements. Qualitative factors include the general economic environment in the Company’s markets, including economic conditions throughout the Midwest and, in particular, the state of certain industries. Size and complexity of individual credits in relation to loan structure, existing loan policies, and pace of portfolio growth are other qualitative factors that are considered in the methodology. As the Company adds new products and increases the complexity of its loan portfolio, it will enhance its methodology accordingly. Management may have reported a materially different amount for the provision for loan losses in the statement of operations to change the allowance for loan losses if its assessment of the above factors were different. Although management believes the levels of the allowance as of both September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010 were adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio, a decline in local economic conditions or other factors could result in increasing losses.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill represents the excess of acquisition costs over the fair value of the net assets acquired in a purchase acquisition. Intangible assets include patents filed by the MPS Division. Goodwill and intangible assets are tested annually for impairment or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment. Determining the fair value of a reporting unit involves the use of significant estimates and assumptions. These estimates and assumptions include revenue growth rates and operating margins used to calculate future cash flows, risk-adjusted discount rates, future economic and market conditions, comparison of the Company’s market value to book value and determination of appropriate market comparables. Actual future results may differ from those estimates.

Each quarter the Company evaluates the estimated useful lives of intangible assets and whether events or changes in circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining periods of amortization. In accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 350, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, recoverability of these assets is measured by comparison of the carrying amount of the asset to the future undiscounted cash flows the asset is expected to generate. If the asset is considered to be impaired, the amount of any impairment is measured as the difference between the carrying value and the fair value of the impaired asset.

Assumptions and estimates about future values and remaining useful lives of the Company’s intangible and other long-lived assets are complex and subjective. They can be affected by a variety of factors, including external factors such as industry and economic trends, and internal factors such as changes in the Company’s business strategy and internal forecasts. Although the Company believes the historical assumptions and estimates used are reasonable and appropriate, different assumptions and estimates could materially impact the reported financial results.


Self-Insurance. The Company has a self-insured healthcare plan for its employees up to certain limits. To mitigate a portion of these risks, the Company has a stop-loss insurance policy through a commercial insurance carrier for coverage in excess of $55,000 per individual occurrence with an unlimited lifetime maximum. The estimate of self-insurance liability is based upon known claims and an estimate of incurred, but not reported (“IBNR”) claims. IBNR claims are estimated using historical claims lag information received by a third party claims administrator. Due to the uncertainty of health claims, the approach includes a process which may differ significantly from other methodologies and still produce an estimate in accordance with GAAP. Although management believes it uses the best information available to determine the accrual, unforeseen health claims could result in adjustments to the accrual.

Deferred Tax Assets. The Company accounts for income taxes according to the asset and liability method. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax basis. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates applicable to income for the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. Deferred tax assets are recognized subject to management’s judgment that realization is more-likely-than-not. An estimate of probable income tax benefits that will not be realized in future years is required in determining the necessity for a valuation allowance. There was no deferred tax valuation allowance at September 30, 2011 and 2010.

Security Impairment. Management continually monitors the investment security portfolio for impairment on a security by security basis. Management has a process in place to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other than temporary. This process involves the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, cash flow projections, and the Company's intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost which, in some cases, may extend to maturity. To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized. If the Company intends to sell a security or it is more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, less any current period credit loss, the Company recognizes an other-than-temporary impairment in earnings for the difference between amortized cost and fair value. If we do not expect to recover the amortized cost basis, we do not plan to sell the security and if it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, less any current period credit loss, the recognition of the other-than-temporary impairment is bifurcated. For those securities, the Company separates the total impairment into a credit loss component recognized in earnings, and the amount of the loss related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income net of taxes.

The amount of the credit loss component of a debt security impairment is estimated as the difference between amortized cost and the present value of the expected cash flows of the security. The present value is determined using the best estimate cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate implicit to the security at the date of purchase or the current yield to accrete an asset- backed or floating rate security. Cash flow estimates for trust preferred securities are derived from scenario-based outcomes of forecasted default rates, loss severity, prepayment speeds and structural support.

In fiscal 2011, there were no other than temporary impairment losses. In fiscal 2010, the other than temporary impairment losses recognized in earnings was $350,000. There were no other than temporary impairment losses in fiscal 2009.

Level 3 Fair Value Measurement. GAAP requires the Company to measure the fair value of financial instruments under a standard which describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value. Level 3 measurement includes significant unobservable inputs that reflect the Company's own assumptions about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset or liability. Level 3 assets and liabilities include financial instruments whose value is determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies, or similar techniques, as well as instruments for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation. Although management believes that it uses a best estimate of information available to determine fair value, due to the uncertainty of future events, the approach includes a process that may differ significantly from other methodologies and still produce an estimate that is in accordance with GAAP.


Net Portfolio Value.

Asset/Liability and Risk Management. Interest rate risk is the most significant market risk affecting the Company. Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange rate risk and commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company's business activities. The Bank, like other financial institutions, is subject to interest rate risk to the extent that its interest-bearing liabilities with short- and medium-term maturities mature or reprice more rapidly than its interest-earning assets. The Company does not currently engage in trading activities to control interest rate risk although it may do so in the future, if deemed necessary, to help manage interest rate risk.

As a continuing part of its financial strategy, the Bank considers methods of managing this asset/liability mismatch consistent with maintaining acceptable levels of net interest income. In order to properly monitor interest rate risk, the Board of Directors has created an Investment Committee whose principal responsibilities are to assess the Bank's asset/liability mix and implement strategies that will enhance income while managing the Bank's vulnerability to changes in interest rates. In managing market risk and the asset/liability mix, the Bank has placed its emphasis on developing a portfolio in which, to the extent practicable, assets and liabilities reprice within similar periods. The goal of this policy is to provide a relatively consistent level of net interest income in varying interest rate cycles and to minimize the potential for significant fluctuations from period to period. One approach used to quantify interest rate risk is the Bank's net portfolio value ("NPV") analysis. In essence, this analysis calculates the difference between the present value of the liabilities and the present value of expected cash flows from assets and off-balance sheet contracts.

Even if interest rates change in the designated amounts, there can be no assurance that the Company's assets and liabilities would perform as set forth below. In addition, a change in U.S. Treasury rates in the designated amounts accompanied by a change in the shape of the Treasury yield curve would cause significantly different changes to the NPV than indicated below.

Presented below, as of September 30, 2011 and 2010, is an analysis of the Bank's interest rate risk as measured by changes in NPV for an instantaneous and sustained parallel shift in the yield curve, in 100 basis point increments, up and down 200 basis points. Down 100 basis points and down 200 basis points are not presented for September 30, 2011 and 2010 due to the extremely low rate environment. At both September 30, 2011 and 2010, the Bank’s interest rate risk profile was within the interest sensitivity limits set by the Board of Directors as listed below. As of September 30, 2011, the Bank’s interest rate risk profile was within the limits set forth by the regulatory agencies.

 
 
September 30, 2011
   
September 30, 2010
 
         
Estimated Increase
               
Estimated Increase
 
   
Estimated
   
(Decrease) in NPV
         
Estimated
   
(Decrease) in NPV
 
Change in
 
NPV
               
Change in
   
NPV
             
Interest Rates
 
Amount
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Interest Rates
   
Amount
   
Amount
   
Percent
 
         
(Dollars in Thousands)
                     
(Dollars in Thousands)
       
Basis Points
                   
Basis Points
                   
+200 bp
    129,699       32,174       32.99 %     +200 bp     79,622       7,624       10.59 %
+100 bp
    121,361       23,836       24.44 %     +100 bp     83,851       11,853       16.46 %
 -
    97,525       -       -       -       71,998       -       -  

Certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of analysis presented in the table. For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods to repricing, they may react in different degrees to changes in market interest rates. Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities may fluctuate in advance of changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in market rates. Additionally, certain assets, such as adjustable rate mortgage loans, have features that restrict changes in interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the asset. Furthermore, although management has estimated changes in the levels of prepayments and early withdrawal in these rate environments, such levels would likely deviate from those assumed in calculating the table. Finally, the ability of some borrowers to service their debt may decrease in the event of an interest rate increase.


Asset Quality

It is management's belief, based on information available at fiscal year end, that the Company's current asset quality is satisfactory. At September 30, 2011, non-performing assets, consisting of impaired/non-accruing loans, accruing loans delinquent 90 days or more, restructured loans, foreclosed real estate, and repossessed consumer property, totaled $15.9 million, or 1.2% of total assets, compared to $9.7 million, or 0.9% of total assets, at September 30, 2010.

Impaired/non-accruing and restructured loans at September 30, 2011 totaled $13.2 million. There were $2.7 million in foreclosed real estate and repossessed assets at September 30, 2011.

The Company maintains an allowance for loan losses because of the potential that some loans may not be repaid in full. See Note 1 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. At September 30, 2011, the Company had an allowance for loan losses in the amount of $4.9 million as compared to $5.2 million at September 30, 2010. Management’s periodic review of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses is based on various subjective and objective factors including the Company’s past loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral, and current economic conditions. While management may allocate portions of the allowance for specifically identified problem loan situations, the majority of the allowance is based on judgmental factors related to the overall loan portfolio and is available for any loan charge-offs that may occur. As stated previously, there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods. In addition, the Bank is subject to review by the OCC, which has the authority to require management to make changes to the allowance for loan losses, and the Company is subject to similar review by the Federal Reserve.

In determining the allowance for loan losses, the Company specifically identifies loans that it considers to have potential collectibility problems. Based on criteria established by ASC 310, some of these loans are considered to be “impaired” while others are not considered to be impaired, but possess weaknesses that the Company believes merit additional analysis in establishing the allowance for loan losses. All other loans are evaluated by applying estimated loss ratios to various pools of loans. The Company then analyzes other factors (such as economic conditions) in determining the aggregate amount of the allowance needed.

At September 30, 2011, $2.1 million of the allowance for loan losses was allocated to impaired loans, representing 10.3% of the related loan balances. See Note 4 of the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. $280,000 of the allowance was allocated to other identified problem loan situations, representing 1.3% of the related loan balances, and $2.5 million, representing 1.0% of the related loan balances, was allocated to the remaining overall loan portfolio based on historical loss experience and general economic conditions. At September 30, 2010, $1.3 million of the allowance for loan losses was allocated to impaired loans, representing 9.7% of the related loan balances. $606,000 was allocated to other identified problem loan situations, and $3.3 million was allocated against losses from the overall loan portfolio based on historical loss experience and general economic conditions.

The Company maintains a loan review and classification process which involves multiple officers of the Company and is designed to assess the general quality of credit underwriting and to promote early identification of potential problem loans. All loan officers are charged with the responsibility of risk rating all loans in their portfolios and updating the ratings, positively or negatively, on an ongoing basis as conditions warrant. A quarterly loan officer validation worksheet documents this process.
 
The level of potential problem loans is another predominant factor in determining the relative level of risk in the loan portfolio and in determining the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses.  Potential problem loans are generally defined by management to include loans rated as substandard by management but that are not considered impaired (i.e., nonaccrual loans and accruing troubled debt restructurings); however, there are circumstances present to create doubt as to the ability of the borrower to comply with present repayment terms.  The decision of management to include performing loans in potential problem loans does not necessarily mean that the Company expects losses to occur, but that management recognizes a higher degree or risk associated with these loans.  The loans that have been reported as potential problem loans are predominantly commercial loans covering a diverse range of businesses and real estate property types.  At September 30, 2011, potential problem loans totaled $7.0 million, compared to $6.4 million at September 30, 2010.  The $0.6 million increase in potential problem loans since September 30, 2010, was primarily due to a $0.9 million increase in commercial real estate and multi family, which is partially offset in all other loan categories.  The level of potential problem loans highlights management’s continued heightened level of uncertainty of the pace at which a commercial credit may deteriorate, the duration of asset quality stress, and uncertainty around the magnitude and scope of economic stress that may be felt by the Company’s customers and on underlying real estate values (both residential and commercial).
 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

The Company's primary sources of funds are deposits, borrowings, principal and interest payments on loans and mortgage-backed securities, and maturing investment securities. While scheduled loan repayments and maturing investments are relatively predictable, deposit flows and early loan repayments are influenced by the level of interest rates, general economic conditions, and competition.

The Company relies on advertising, quality customer service, convenient locations, and competitive pricing to attract and retain its deposits and only solicits these deposits from its primary market area. Based on its experience, the Company believes that its consumer checking, savings, and money market accounts are relatively stable sources of deposits. The Company’s ability to attract and retain time deposits has been, and will continue to be, affected by market conditions. However, the Company does not foresee any significant retail funding issues resulting from the sensitivity of time deposits to such market factors.

The Company is aware that the low- and no-cost checking deposits generated through MPS may carry a greater degree of concentration risk than traditional consumer checking deposits. To date, the Company has not experienced any significant net outflows related to MPS over the past seven years, though no assurance can be given that this will continue to be the case. As a result of the OTS administrative actions, it is possible that the Bank may experience migration of third-parties with which it does business to other banks that are able to operate without restrictions. One such third party in fiscal 2010 announced its intention to diversify its business, although it continues to maintain a strong business relationship with the Bank. While no such migrations have occurred in material amount since OTS restrictions were announced in October 2010, we cannot predict the extent to which third-parties with whom we do business will migrate their business to other banks, or the extent to which such migration will reduce our low and no-cost deposits. If such reductions occur in a material amount, the Company’s financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

The Bank is required by regulation to maintain sufficient liquidity to assure its safe and sound operation. In the opinion of management, the Bank is in compliance with this requirement.

Liquidity management is both a daily and long-term function of the Company's management strategy. The Company adjusts its investments in liquid assets based upon management's assessment of (i) expected loan demand, (ii) the projected availability of purchased loan products, (iii) expected deposit flows, (iv) yields available on interest-bearing deposits, and (v) the objectives of its asset/liability management program. Excess liquidity is generally invested in interest-earning overnight deposits and other short-term government agency obligations. If the Company requires funds beyond its ability to generate them internally, it has additional borrowing capacity with the FHLB and other wholesale funding sources. The Company is not aware of any significant trends in the Company’s liquidity or its ability to borrow additional funds if needed.

By letter dated December 28, 2010, the OTS directed the Bank not to increase the amount of brokered deposits from the amount it held at December 28, 2010 without the prior written non-objection of the OTS Regional Director. The Bank believes it did not hold any brokered deposits on December 28, 2010 or thereafter and therefore does not anticipate seeking approval. At the direction of the OTS, the Bank requested the FDIC to confirm that deposits related to a specific prepaid program were not brokered deposits. The Bank has not yet received a reply from FDIC. At the time the directive was issued, OTS staff stated that it would not seek retroactively to enforce the directive for any growth that occurs subsequent to December 28, 2010, given the Bank's request to the FDIC. The Bank tendered its request to the FDIC in December 2010. The Bank has been advised that the FDIC will consider the Bank's request in the context of its broader industry reevaluation of brokered deposits in general. In addition, under current rules, if a substantial portion of the Bank's deposits are ruled to be "brokered," and should the Bank's primary federal regulator decide to impose a formal individual minimum capital requirement or similar formal requirement on the Bank notwithstanding that the Bank is well-capitalized, the Bank would be prohibited, absent waiver from the FDIC, from utilizing brokered deposits. In either event, unless the Bank receives relief from its regulator or a waiver from the FDIC, such a result could produce serious adverse consequences for the Bank from a liquidity standpoint and could also have serious adverse effects on the Company's financial condition and results of operations.


The primary investing activities of the Company are the origination and purchase of loans and the purchase of securities. During the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company originated loans totaling $1.1 billion, $1.2 billion, and $686.1 million, respectively. Most of these loans were sold without recourse after origination. Purchases of loans totaled $5.8 million, $8.9 million, and $50.4 million during the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. During the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company purchased mortgage-backed securities and other securities available for sale in the amount of $289.8 million, $437.3 million and $287.1 million, respectively.

At September 30, 2011, the Company had unfunded loan commitments of $48.0 million. See Note 15 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Certificates of deposit scheduled to mature in one year or less from September 30, 2011 totaled $62.4 million. Based on its historical experience, management believes that a significant portion of such deposits will remain with the Company; however, there can be no assurance that the Company can retain all such deposits. Management believes that loan repayment and other sources of funds will be adequate to meet the Company's foreseeable short- and long-term liquidity needs.

The following table summarizes the Company’s significant contractual obligations at September 30, 2011 (Dollars in Thousands):

Contractual Obligations
 
Total
   
Less than 1 year
   
1 to 3 years
   
3 to 5 years
   
More than 5 years
 
                               
Time deposits
  $ 116,562     $ 62,357     $ 47,328     $ 6,877     $ -  
Long-term debt
    19,055       8,055       2,500       1,500       7,000  
Operating leases
    9,456       1,548       2,539       2,276       3,093  
Subordinate debentures
                                       
Issued to capital trust
    10,310       -       -       -       10,310  
Data processing services
    4,112       1,946       2,166       -       -  
Total
  $ 159,495     $ 73,906     $ 54,533     $ 10,653     $ 20,403  

During July 2001, the Company’s unconsolidated trust subsidiary, First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I, sold $10.0 million in floating rate cumulative preferred securities. Proceeds from the sale were used to purchase subordinated debentures of the Company, which mature in the year 2031, and are redeemable at any time after five years. The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has the option to redeem. The Company used the proceeds for general corporate purposes. See Note 10 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company and the Bank met regulatory requirements for classification as well capitalized institutions. See Note 14 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The payment of dividends and repurchase of shares has the effect of reducing stockholders’ equity. Prior to authorizing such transactions, the Board of Directors considers the effect the dividend or repurchase of shares would have on liquidity and regulatory capital ratios. Further, the Company must seek the approval of the Federal Reserve prior to declaring dividends or capital distributions, or redeeming or purchasing Company equity stock.

At the Bank level, the Board of Directors has approved a goal of an 8% Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets ratio during fiscal 2011. At September 30, 2011, the Bank’s Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets ratio was 6.38%, well in excess of the five percent minimum to attain well-capitalized status and the Bank’s average Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets ratio was 7.0%. No assurance can be provided that the Board of Director’s goal will be achieved.


Off-Balance Sheet Financing Arrangements

For discussion of the Company’s off-balance sheet financing arrangements, see Note 15 of “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Depending on the extent to which the commitments or contingencies described in Note 16 occur, the effect on the Company’s capital and net income could be significant.

Impact of Inflation and Changing Prices

The Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto presented in this Annual Report have been prepared in accordance with GAAP, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars without considering the change in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation. The primary impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost of the Company's operations. Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all the assets and liabilities of the Company are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates generally have a more significant impact on a financial institution's performance than do the effects of general levels of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction, or to the same extent, as the prices of goods and services.

Impact of New Accounting Standards

           Accounting Standards Update No.2010-20, "Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the Allowance for Credit Losses" (ASC Topic 310).
This ASU required significant new disclosures about the allowance for credit losses and the credit quality of financing receivables. The requirements are intended to enhance transparency regarding credit losses and the credit quality of loan and lease receivables. Under this statement, allowance for credit losses and fair value are to be disclosed by portfolio segment, while credit quality information, impaired financing receivables and nonaccrual status are to be presented by class of financing receivable. Disclosure of the nature and extent, the financial impact and segment information of restructured loans will also be required. The disclosures are to be presented at the level of disaggregation that management uses when assessing and monitoring the portfolio's risk and performance. The Company adopted this update effective in the first quarter of fiscal 2011 and the adoption did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-01, "Deferral of the Effective Date of Disclosures about Troubled Debt Restructurings in Update No. 2010-20" (ASC Topic 310).
This ASU modified the effective date of compliance with disclosure requirements related to trouble debt restructure reporting previously indicated in ASU 2010-20. The new effective date for disclosing the required troubled debt restructuring information is for interim and annual periods ending after June 15, 2011. The Company adopted this update effective in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 and the adoption did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-02, Receivables (Topic 310): A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring Is a Troubled Debt Restructuring
This ASU amends guidance for evaluating whether the restructuring of a receivable by a creditor is a troubled debt restructuring (TDR). The ASU responds to concerns that creditors are inconsistently applying existing guidance for identifying TDRs. ASU 2011-02 is effective for a public entity for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011. Retrospective application is required for restructurings occurring on or after the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption for purposes of identifying and disclosing TDRs. However, an entity should apply prospectively changes in the method used to calculate impairment on receivables. At the same time it adopts ASU 2011-02, a public entity will be required to disclose the activity-based information about TDRs that was previously deferred by ASU No. 2011-01, Deferral of the Effective Date of Disclosures about Troubled Debt Restructurings in Update No. 2010-20. The Company adopted ASU 2011-02 for the interim and annual period ending September 30, 2011. The adoption did not have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations, or cash flow.


Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-03, Transfer and Servicing (Topic 860): Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements
This ASU applies to all entities that enter into agreements to transfer financial assets that both entitle and obligate the transferor to repurchase or redeem the financial assets before their maturity (repo arrangements). It focuses the transferor’s assessment of effective control on its contractual rights and obligations by removing the requirement to assess its ability to exercise those rights or honor those obligations. The ASU is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011. It is effective prospectively for transactions or modifications of existing transactions that occur on or after the effective date. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-03 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011 and the Company does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs
This ASU was issued concurrently with IFRS 13, Fair Value Measurements, to provide largely identical guidance about fair value measurement and disclosure requirements. The new standards do not extend the use of fair value but, rather, provide guidance about how fair value should be applied where it already is required or permitted under IFRS or U.S. GAAP. For U.S. GAAP, most of the changes are clarifications of existing guidance or wording changes to align with IFRS 13.

A public entity is required to apply the ASU prospectively for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is not permitted. In the period of adoption, a reporting entity will be required to disclose a change, if any, in valuation technique and related inputs that result from applying the ASU and to quantify the total effect, if practicable. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-04 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011 and the Company does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations, or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Presentation of Comprehensive Income
This ASU increases the prominence of other comprehensive income in financial statements. Under this ASU, an entity will have the option to present the components of net income and comprehensive income in either one or two consecutive financial statements. The ASU eliminates the option in U.S. GAAP to present other comprehensive income in the statement of changes in equity.

An entity should apply the ASU retrospectively. For a public entity, the ASU is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-05 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-08 “Intangibles — Goodwill and Other” (ASC Topic 350).
The objective of this update is to simplify how entities test goodwill for impairment. This update adds a qualitative analysis to step one of the two-step process, which enables the Company to qualitatively determine if it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists, and if not, skip step two in determination of the amount of goodwill impairment. The guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011, but early adoption is permitted. The Company anticipates adopting this update in the second quarter of fiscal 2012 and does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Item 7A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk

As stated above, the Company derives a portion of its income from the excess of interest collected over interest paid. The rates of interest the Company earns on assets and pays on liabilities generally are established contractually for a period of time. Market interest rates change over time. Accordingly, the Company’s results of operations, like those of most financial institutions, are impacted by changes in interest rates and the interest rate sensitivity of its assets and liabilities. The risk associated with changes in interest rates and the Company’s ability to adapt to these changes is known as interest rate risk and is the Company’s only significant “market” risk.


The Company monitors and measures its exposure to changes in interest rates in order to comply with applicable government regulations and risk policies established by the Board of Directors, and in order to preserve stockholder value. In monitoring interest rate risk, the Company analyzes assets and liabilities based on characteristics including size, coupon rate, repricing frequency, maturity date, and likelihood of prepayment.

If the Company’s assets mature or reprice more rapidly or to a greater extent than its liabilities, then net portfolio value and net interest income would tend to increase during periods of rising rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates. Conversely, if the Company’s assets mature or reprice more slowly or to a lesser extent than its liabilities, then net portfolio value and net interest income would tend to decrease during periods of rising interest rates and increase during periods of falling interest rates.

The Company currently focuses lending efforts toward originating and purchasing competitively priced adjustable-rate and fixed-rate loan products with short to intermediate terms to maturity, generally 5 years or less. This theoretically allows the Company to maintain a portfolio of loans that will have relatively little sensitivity to changes in the level of interest rates, while providing a reasonable spread to the cost of liabilities used to fund the loans.

The Company's primary objective for its investment portfolio is to provide a source of liquidity for the Company. In addition, the investment portfolio may be used in the management of the Company’s interest rate risk profile. The investment policy generally calls for funds to be invested among various categories of security types and maturities based upon the Company's need for liquidity, desire to achieve a proper balance between minimizing risk while maximizing yield, the need to provide collateral for borrowings, and to fulfill the Company's asset/liability management goals.

The Company's cost of funds responds to changes in interest rates due to the relatively short-term nature of its deposit portfolio, and due to the relatively short-term nature of its borrowed funds. The Company believes that its growing portfolio of low- or no-cost deposits provides a stable and profitable funding vehicle, but also subjects the Company to greater risk in a falling interest rate environment than it would otherwise have without this portfolio. This risk is due to the fact that, while asset yields may decrease in a falling interest rate environment, the Company cannot significantly reduce interest costs associated with these deposits, which thereby compresses the Company’s net interest margin. As a result of the Company’s new interest rate risk exposure in this regard, the Company has elected not to enter in to any new longer term wholesale borrowings, and generally has not emphasized longer term time deposit products.

The Board of Directors and relevant government regulations establish limits on the level of acceptable interest rate risk at the Company, to which management adheres. There can be no assurance, however, that, in the event of an adverse change in interest rates, the Company's efforts to limit interest rate risk will be successful.


Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
87
     
Consolidated Financial Statements
   
Statements of Financial Condition
 
88
Statements of Operations
 
89
Statements of Comprehensive Income
 
90
Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity
 
91
Statements of Cash Flows
 
92
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
94


KPMG LLP
2500 Ruan Center
666 Grand Avenue
Des Moines, IA 50309


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Meta Financial Group, Inc.:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial conditions of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended September 30, 2011. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 2011 and 2010, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended September 30, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Meta Financial Group’s, Inc. internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated December 19, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 
/s/ KPMG LLP

Des Moines, Iowa
December 19, 2011


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)


ASSETS
 
September 30, 2011
   
September 30, 2010
 
             
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 276,893     $ 87,503  
Investment securities available for sale
    28,330       21,467  
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale
    590,918       485,385  
Loans receivable - net of allowance for loan losses of $4,926 at September 30, 2011 and $5,234 at September 30, 2010
    314,410       366,045  
Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost
    4,737       5,283  
Accrued interest receivable
    4,133       4,759  
Insurance receivable
    2,264       3,683  
Premises, furniture, and equipment, net
    17,168       19,377  
Bank-owned life insurance
    14,322       13,796  
Foreclosed real estate and repossessed assets
    2,671       1,295  
Goodwill and intangible assets
    1,315       2,663  
MPS accounts receivable
    7,677       8,085  
Other assets
    10,643       10,425  
                 
Total assets
  $ 1,275,481     $ 1,029,766  
                 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
                 
LIABILITIES
               
Non-interest-bearing checking
  $ 945,956     $ 675,163  
Interest-bearing checking
    31,249       29,976  
Savings deposits
    11,136       10,821  
Money market deposits
    36,717       35,422  
Time certificates of deposit
    116,562       146,072  
Total deposits
    1,141,620       897,454  
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
    11,000       22,000  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    8,055       8,904  
Subordinated debentures
    10,310       10,310  
Accrued interest payable
    223       392  
Contingent liability
    3,649       3,983  
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
    20,047       14,679  
Total liabilities
    1,194,904       957,722  
                 
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
               
                 
STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Preferred stock, 800,000 shares authorized, no shares issued or outstanding
    -       -  
Common stock, $.01 par value; 5,200,000 shares authorized, 3,372,999 shares issued, 3,146,867 and 3,111,413 shares outstanding at September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010, respectively
    34       34  
Additional paid-in capital
    32,471       32,381  
Retained earnings - substantially restricted
    45,494       42,475  
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    6,336       1,599  
Treasury stock, 226,132 and 261,586 common shares, at cost, at September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010, respectively
    (3,758 )     (4,445 )
Total stockholders’ equity
    80,577       72,044  
                 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
  $ 1,275,481     $ 1,029,766  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)

   
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Interest and dividend income:
                 
Loans receivable, including fees
  $ 19,654     $ 24,944     $ 25,561  
Mortgage-backed securities
    18,362       13,370       10,230  
Other investments
    1,043       769       935  
      39,059       39,083       36,726  
Interest expense:
                       
Deposits
    3,069       3,908       5,341  
FHLB advances and other borrowings
    1,678       2,085       3,566  
      4,747       5,993       8,907  
Net interest income
    34,312       33,090       27,819  
Provision for loan losses
    278       15,791       18,713  
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
    34,034       17,299       9,106  
Non-interest income:
                       
Card fees
    53,890       93,206       77,502  
Gain on sale of securities available for sale, net
    1,793       2,140       761  
Deposit fees
    649       766       749  
Bank-owned life insurance income
    526       526       512  
Loan fees
    417       359       660  
Gain on sale of membership equity interests, net
    -       -       515  
Gain (loss) on sale of REO
    53       (105 )     (1,015 )
Other income
    163       552       285  
Total non-interest income
    57,491       97,444       79,969  
                         
Non-interest expense:
                       
Compensation and benefits
    30,467       32,529       32,743  
Card processing expense
    23,286       38,242       33,540  
Occupancy and equipment expense
    8,467       8,162       7,978  
Legal and consulting expense
    5,156       3,464       3,745  
Goodwill impairment
    1,508       -       -  
Marketing
    1,260       2,109       1,822  
Data processing expense
    1,092       1,273       2,181  
Other expense
    12,026       9,151       9,072  
Total non-interest expense
    83,262       94,930       91,081  
                         
Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
    8,263       19,813       (2,006 )
Income tax expense (benefit)
    3,623       7,420       (543 )
                         
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,393     $ (1,463 )
                         
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                       
Basic
  $ 1.49     $ 4.23     $ (0.56 )
Diluted
  $ 1.49     $ 4.11     $ (0.56 )
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 

META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
(Dollars in Thousands)

   
For the Years Ended
 
   
September 30,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,393     $ (1,463 )
                         
Other comprehensive income:
                       
Change in net unrealized gains on securities available for sale
    9,464       7,661       5,839  
(Gains) realized in net income
    (1,793 )     (2,140 )     (761 )
      7,671       5,521       5,078  
Deferred income tax effect
    2,934       2,084       1,894  
Total other comprehensive income
    4,737       3,437       3,184  
Total comprehensive income
  $ 9,377     $ 15,830     $ 1,721  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 

META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity
For the Years Ended September 30, 2009, 2010 and 2011
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)

   
Common Stock
   
Additional Paid-in Capital
   
Retained Earnings
   
Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Loss),Net of Tax
   
Treasury Stock
   
Total Shareholders’ Equity
 
                                     
                                     
Balance, September 30, 2008
  $ 30     $ 23,058     $ 34,442     $ (5,022 )   $ (6,775 )   $ 45,733  
                                                 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($.52 per share)
    -       -       (1,353 )     -       -       (1,353 )
                                                 
Issuance of 21,624 common shares from treasury stock due to exercise of stock options
    -       (153 )     -       -       168       15  
                                                 
Stock compensation
    -       641       -       -       148       789  
                                                 
18,446 common shares committed to be released under the ESOP
    -       5       -       -       435       440  
                                                 
Change in net unrealized losses on securities available for sale, net
                                               
                                                 
Net loss
    -       -       (1,463 )     -       -       (1,463 )
                                                 
Balance, September 30, 2009
  $ 30     $ 23,551     $ 31,626     $ (1,838 )   $ (6,024 )   $ 47,345  
                                                 
                                                 
Balance, September 30, 2009
  $ 30     $ 23,551     $ 31,626     $ (1,838 )   $ (6,024 )   $ 47,345  
                                                 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($.52 per share)
    -       -       (1,544 )     -       -       (1,544 )
                                                 
Issuance of common shares from the sales of equity securities
    4       8,563       -       -       -       8,567  
                                                 
Issuance of 41,544 common shares from treasury stock due to exercise of stock options
    -       (249 )     -       -       1,579       1,330  
                                                 
Stock compensation
    -       516       -       -       -       516  
                                                 
Change in net unrealized losses on securities available for sale, net
                                               
                                                 
Net income
    -       -       12,393       -       -       12,393  
                                                 
Balance, September 30, 2010
  $ 34     $ 32,381     $ 42,475     $ 1,599     $ (4,445 )   $ 72,044  
                                                 
                                                 
Balance, September 30, 2010
  $ 34     $ 32,381     $ 42,475     $ 1,599     $ (4,445 )   $ 72,044  
                                                 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($.52 per share)
    -       -       (1,621 )     -       -       (1,621 )
                                                 
Issuance of common shares from the sales of equity securities
    -       -       -       -       -       -  
                                                 
Issuance of 13,776 common shares from treasury stock due to exercise of stock options
    -       (112 )     -       -       687       575  
                                                 
Stock compensation
    -       202       -       -       -       202  
                                                 
Change in net unrealized gains on securities available for sale, net
                                               
                                                 
Net income
    -       -       4,640       -       -       4,640  
                                                 
Balance, September 30, 2011
  $ 34     $ 32,471     $ 45,494     $ 6,336     $ (3,758 )   $ 80,577  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 

META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
(Dollars in Thousands)

   
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Cash flows from operating activities:
                 
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,393     $ (1,463 )
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:
                       
Effect of contribution to employee stock ownership plan
    -       -       440  
Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
    9,758       11,434       5,970  
Disbursement of non-real estate consumer loans originated
    (848,671 )     (440,175 )     (126,857 )
Proceeds from sale of non-real estate consumer loans
    848,553       438,339       126,963  
Disbursement of 1-4 family residential mortgage loans originated
    (2,370 )     (3,393 )     (3,428 )
Proceeds from sale of 1-4 family residential mortgage loans
    3,627       2,466       3,225  
Gain on sale of loans
    (188 )     (83 )     (67 )
Provision for loan losses
    278       15,791       18,713  
Gain on sale of investments available for sale, net
    (1,793 )     (2,140 )     (761 )
Gain on sale of membership equity interests, net
    -       -       (515 )
Loss on sale of other assets
    102       123       1,015  
Net change in accrued interest receivable
    626       (415 )     153  
Goodwill impairment
    1,508       -       -  
Net change in other assets
    923       (1,935 )     (460 )
Net change in accrued interest payable
    (169 )     (55 )     (131 )
Net change in accrued expenses and other liabilities
    5,034       2,220       4  
Net cash provided by operating activities
    21,858       34,570       22,801  
                         
Cash flows from investing activities:
                       
Purchase of securities available for sale
    (289,777 )     (437,305 )     (287,113 )
Net change in federal funds sold
    -       9       5,179  
Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale
    55,791       97,610       32,478  
Proceeds from maturities and principal repayments of securities available for sale
    125,085       197,346       97,184  
Loans purchased
    (5,820 )     (8,930 )     (50,358 )
Net change in loans receivable
    53,856       21,097       64,102  
Proceeds from sales of foreclosed real estate
    1,047       1,105       958  
Net change in FHLB stock
    546       1,767       1,042  
Proceeds from the sale of premises and equipment
    98       1,154       2  
Purchase of premises and equipment
    (1,832 )     (2,347 )     (3,683 )
Other, net
    (2,935 )     (1,735 )     (1,894 )
Net cash used in investing activities
    (63,941 )     (130,229 )     (142,103 )
                         
Cash flows from financing activities:
                       
Net change in checking, savings, and money market deposits
    273,676       243,798       131,271  
Net change in time deposits
    (29,510 )     (91 )     22,672  
Net change in advances from FHLB and other borrowings
    (11,000 )     (77,800 )     (32,225 )
Net change in securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    (849 )     2,218       1,338  
Cash dividends paid
    (1,621 )     (1,544 )     (1,353 )
Stock compensation
    202       516       789  
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
    575       9,897       15  
Net cash provided by financing activities
    231,473       176,994       122,507  
                         
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
    189,390       81,335       3,205  
                         
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    87,503       6,168       2,963  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 276,893     $ 87,503     $ 6,168  


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (Con't.)
(Dollars in Thousands)

   
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
                   
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information
                 
Cash paid during the year for:
                 
Interest
  $ 4,916     $ 6,048     $ 9,038  
Income taxes
    3,255       3,559       2,607  
                         
Supplemental disclosure of non-cash investing and financing activities:
                       
Net loans transferred to foreclosed real estate
  $ 2,370     $ 452     $ 4,026  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Meta Financial Group, Inc. (the “Company”), a unitary savings and loan holding company located in Storm Lake, Iowa, and its wholly owned subsidiaries which include MetaBank (the “Bank”), a federally chartered savings bank whose primary federal regulator is the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, First Services Financial Limited and Brookings Service Corporation, which offer noninsured investment products. The Company also owns 100% of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I (the “Trust”), which was formed in July 2001 for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities. The Trust is not included in the consolidated financial statements of the Company. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.

NATURE OF BUSINESS AND INDUSTRY SEGMENT INFORMATION

The primary source of income for the Company is interest from the purchase or origination of consumer, commercial, agricultural, commercial real estate, and residential real estate loans. Additionally, a significant source of income for the Company relates to payment processing services for prepaid debit cards, ATM sponsorship, and other money transfer systems and services. The Company accepts deposits from customers in the normal course of business primarily in northwest and central Iowa and eastern South Dakota and on a national basis for the MPS division. The Company operates in the banking industry, which accounts for the majority of its revenues and assets. The Company uses the “management approach” for reporting information about segments in annual and interim financial statements. The management approach is based on the way the chief operating decision-maker organizes segments within a company for making operating decisions and assessing performance. Reportable segments are based on products and services, geography, legal structure, management structure and any other manner in which management disaggregates a company. Based on the management approach model, the Company has determined that its business is comprised of two reporting segments.

Assets held in trust or fiduciary capacity are not assets of the Company and, accordingly, are not included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

USE OF ESTIMATES IN PREPARING FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Certain significant estimates include the allowance for loan losses, the valuation of goodwill and the fair values of securities and other financial instruments. These estimates are reviewed by management regularly; however, they are particularly susceptible to significant changes in the future.

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AND FEDERAL FUNDS SOLD

For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents is defined to include the Company’s cash on hand and due from financial institutions and short-term interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions. The Company reports cash flows net for customer loan transactions, securities purchased under agreement to resell, deposit transactions, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, and FHLB advances with terms less than 90 days. The Bank is required to maintain reserve balances in cash or on deposit with the FRB, based on a percentage of deposits. The total of those reserve balances was $1.4 million and $2.3 million at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The Company at times maintains balances in excess of insured limits at various financial institutions including the FHLB, the FRB, and other private institutions. At September 30, 2011 the Company had no interest bearing deposits held at the FHLB and $271.6 million in interest bearing deposits held at the FRB. At September 30, 2011 the Company had no federal funds sold. The Company does not believe these instruments carry a significant risk of loss, but cannot provide assurances that no losses could occur if these institutions were to become insolvent.


SECURITIES

The Company classifies all securities as available for sale. Available for sale securities are those the Company may decide to sell if needed for liquidity, asset-liability management or other reasons. Available for sale securities are reported at fair value, with net unrealized gains and losses reported as other comprehensive income or loss as a separate component of stockholders’ equity, net of tax.

Gains and losses on the sale of securities are determined using the specific identification method based on amortized cost and are reflected in results of operations at the time of sale. Interest and dividend income, adjusted by amortization of purchase premium or discount over the estimated life of the security using the level yield method, is included in income as earned.

Securities Impairment

Management continually monitors the investment security portfolio for impairment on a security by security basis and has a process in place to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary. This process involves the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, cash flow projections, and the Company's intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost which, in some cases, may extend to maturity. To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized. If the Company intends to sell a security or it is more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, less any current period credit loss, the Company recognizes an other-than-temporary impairment for the difference between amortized cost and fair value. If we do not expect to recover the amortized cost basis, we do not plan to sell the security and if it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of it amortized cost, less any current period credit loss, the recognition of the other-than-temporary impairment is bifurcated. For those securities, the Company separates the total impairment into a credit loss component recognized in net income, and the amount of the loss related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income, net of taxes.

The amount of the credit loss component of a debt security impairment is estimated as the difference between amortized cost and the present value of the expected cash flows of the security. The present value is determined using the best estimate cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate implicit to the security at the date of purchase or the current yield to accrete an asset- backed or floating rate security. In fiscal 2011, there were no other-than-temporary impairments recorded. In fiscal 2010, the other-than-temporary impairments recorded against the trust preferred securities were $350,000. No other-than-temporary impairments were recorded against earnings during fiscal 2009.

LOANS HELD FOR SALE AND IMMATERIAL CORRECTION OF PRIOR PERIOD

The Company originates certain consumer and residential mortgage loans specifically for resale and such loans are held for short periods of time. Such loans are reported at the lower of cost or market value.

Cash receipts and cash payments resulting from acquisitions and sales of such loans are classified as operating cash flows in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

In 2010 and 2009 the Company reported the cash receipts and cash payments from acquisitions and sales of such loans net in the investing section of the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. The Company has adjusted the prior period cash flows for the immaterial error in presentation.

The correction resulted in a decrease in operating cash flows of $2.8 million in 2010 and $97,000 in 2009.


LOANS RECEIVABLE

Loans receivable that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are reported at their outstanding principal balances reduced by the allowance for loan losses and any deferred fees or costs on originated loans.
 
MPS has strived to offer consumers innovative payment products, including credit products. Most credit products have fallen into one of two general categories: (1) sponsorship lending and (2) portfolio lending. In a sponsorship lending model, MPS typically originates loans and sells (without recourse) the resulting receivables to third party investors equipped to take the associated credit risk. MPS’s sponsorship lending programs are governed by the Policy for Sponsorship Lending which has been approved by the Board of Directors. A Portfolio Credit Policy which has been approved by the Board of Directors governs portfolio credit initiatives undertaken by MPS, whereby the Company retains some or all receivables and relies on the borrower as the underlying source of repayment. Several portfolio lending programs also have a contractual provision that has indemnified MPS and the Bank for credit losses that meet or exceed predetermined levels. Such a program carries additional risks not commonly found in sponsorship programs, specifically funding and credit risk. Therefore, MPS has strived to employ policies, procedures, and information systems that are commensurate with the added risk and exposure. Due to supervisory directives issued by our regulator, an MPS lending program - iAdvance – was eliminated effective October 13, 2010. In addition, our third party relationship programs have been limited to third party relationships in existence at the time the directives were issued, absent prior approval to engage in new relationships. For additional discussion, see “Regulation - Bank Supervision and Regulation – OTS Consent Orders and Related Matters.”
 
Interest income on loans is accrued over the term of the loans based upon the amount of principal outstanding except when serious doubt exists as to the collectibility of a loan, in which case the accrual of interest is discontinued. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent that cash payments are received until, in management’s judgment, the borrower has the ability to make contractual interest and principal payments, in which case the loan is returned to accrual status.

Loan fees and certain direct loan origination costs are deferred, and the net fee or cost is recognized as an adjustment to interest income using the interest method.

As part of the Company's ongoing risk management practices, management attempts to work with borrowers when necessary to extend or modify loan terms to better align with their current ability to repay. Extensions and modifications to loans are made in accordance with internal policies and guidelines which conform to regulatory guidance. Each occurrence is unique to the borrower and is evaluated separately. In a situation where an economic concession has been granted to a borrower that is experiencing financial difficulty, the Company identifies and reports that loan as a troubled debt restructuring ("TDR"). Management considers regulatory guidelines when restructuring loans to ensure that prudent lending practices are followed. As such, qualification criteria and payment terms consider the borrower's current and prospective ability to comply with the modified terms of the loan. Additionally, the Company structures loan modifications with the intent of strengthening repayment prospects.

The Company considers whether a borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, as well as whether a concession has been granted to a borrower determined to be troubled, when determining whether a modification meets the criteria of being a TDR under ASC 310-40, Receivables. For such purposes, evidence which may indicate that a borrower is troubled includes, among other factors, the borrower's default on debt, the borrower's declaration of bankruptcy or preparation for the declaration of bankruptcy, the borrower's forecast that entity-specific cash flows will be insufficient to service the related debt, or the borrower's inability to obtain funds from sources other than existing creditors at an effective interest rate equal to the current market interest rate for similar debt for a non-troubled debtor. If a borrower is determined to be troubled based on such factors or similar evidence, a concession will be deemed to have been granted if a modification of the terms of the debt occurred that management would not otherwise consider. Such concessions may include, among other modifications, a reduction of the stated interest for the remaining original life of the debt, an extension of the maturity date at a stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, a reduction of accrued interest, or a reduction of the face amount or maturity amount of the debt.

A modification of loan terms that management would generally not consider to be a TDR could be a temporary extension of maturity to allow a borrower to complete an asset sale whereby the proceeds of such transaction are to be paid to satisfy the outstanding debt. Additionally, a modification that extends the term of a loan, but does not involve reduction of principal or accrued interest, in which the interest rate is adjusted to reflect current market rates for similarly situated borrowers is not considered a TDR. Nevertheless, each assessment will take into account any modified terms and will be comprehensive to ensure appropriate impairment assessment.


Loans that are reported as TDRs apply the identical criteria in the determination of whether the loan should be accruing or nonaccruing. Typically, the event of classifying the loan as a TDR due to a modification of terms is independent from the determination of accruing interest on a loan in accordance with accounting standards.

Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent 90 days or more or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is taken out of current income. The loan will remain on a non-accrual status until the loan becomes current.

MORTGAGE SERVICING AND TRANSFERS OF FINANCIAL ASSETS

The Bank regularly sells residential mortgage loans to others on a non-recourse basis. Sold loans are not included in the consolidated financial statements. The Bank generally retains the right to service the sold loans for a fee. At September 30, 2011 and 2010, the Bank was servicing loans for others with aggregate unpaid principal balances of $24.8 million and $27.1 million, respectively.

ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES

The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable loan losses which have been incurred as of the date of the consolidated financial statements. The allowance for loan losses is increased by a provision for loan losses charged to expense and decreased by charge-offs (net of recoveries). Estimating the risk of loss and the amount of loss on any loan is necessarily subjective. Management’s periodic evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance is based on the Company’s past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral, and current economic conditions. While management may periodically allocate portions of the allowance for specific problem loan situations, the entire allowance is available for any loan charge-offs that occur.

Loans are considered impaired if full principal or interest payments are not probable in accordance with the contractual loan terms. Impaired loans are carried at the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or at the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. A portion of the allowance for loan losses is allocated to impaired loans if the value of such loans is deemed to be less than the unpaid balance. If these allocations cause the allowance for loan losses to require an increase, such increase is reported as a component of the provision for loan losses.

The allowance consists of specific, general, and unallocated components. The specific component relates to impaired loans that are classified either as doubtful or substandard. For such loans, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral value or observable market price) of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan. The general component covers loans not considered impaired and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses. The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio.

Smaller-balance homogeneous loans are evaluated for impairment in total. Such loans include residential first mortgage loans secured by one-to-four family residences, residential construction loans, and automobile, manufactured homes, home equity and second mortgage loans. Commercial and agricultural loans and mortgage loans secured by other properties are evaluated individually for impairment. When analysis of borrower operating results and financial condition indicates that underlying cash flows of the borrower’s business are not adequate to meet its debt service requirements, the loan is evaluated for impairment. Often this is associated with a delay or shortfall in payments of 90 days or more. Generally,  non-accrual loans are considered impaired. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.


FORECLOSED REAL ESTATE AND REPOSSESSED ASSETS

Real estate properties and repossessed assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure are initially recorded at the lower of cost or fair value less selling costs at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis. Any reduction to fair value from the carrying value of the related loan at the time of acquisition is accounted for as a loan loss and charged against the allowance for loan losses. Valuations are periodically performed by management and valuation allowances are increased through a charge to income for reductions in fair value or increases in estimated selling costs.

INCOME TAXES

The Company records income tax expense based on the amount of taxes due on its tax return plus deferred taxes computed based on the expected future tax consequences of temporary differences between the carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, using enacted tax rates. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

In accordance with ASC 740, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, the Company recognizes a tax position as a benefit only if it is more likely than not that the tax position would be sustained in a tax examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur. The amount recognized is the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized upon examination. For tax positions not meeting the more likely than not test, no tax benefit is recorded. The Company recognizes interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense.

PREMISES, FURNITURE, AND EQUIPMENT

Land is carried at cost. Buildings, furniture, fixtures, leasehold improvements and equipment are carried at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization computed principally by using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which range from 10 to 40 years for buildings, and 3 to 10 years for leasehold improvements, for furniture, fixtures and equipment. These assets are reviewed for impairment when events indicate the carrying amount may not be recoverable.

TRANSFERS OF FINANCIAL ASSETS

Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1) the assets have been isolated from the Company, (2) the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and (3) the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

BANK-OWNED LIFE INSURANCE

Bank-owned life insurance represents the cash surrender value of investments in life insurance contracts. Earnings on the contracts are based on the earnings on the cash surrender value, less mortality costs.

EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN

The cost of shares issued to the ESOP, but not yet allocated to participants, are presented in the consolidated statements of financial condition as a reduction of stock­holders’ equity. Compensation expense is recorded based on the market price of the shares as they are committed to be released for allocation to participant accounts. The difference between the market price and the cost of shares committed to be released is recorded as an adjustment to additional paid-in capital. Dividends on allocated ESOP shares are recorded as a reduction of retained earnings. Dividends on unallocated shares are used to reduce the accrued interest and principal amount of the ESOP’s loan payable to the Company.

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK

The Company, in the normal course of business, makes commitments to make loans which are not reflected in the consolidated financial statements.

GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Goodwill and certain intangible assets are not amortized but are subject to an impairment test at least annually or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment.


SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE

The Company enters into sales of securities under agreements to repurchase with primary dealers only, which provide for the repurchase of the same security. Securities sold under agreements to repurchase identical securities are collateralized by assets which are held in safekeeping in the name of the Bank or by the dealers who arranged the transaction. Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as financings, and the obligations to repurchase such securities are reflected as a liability. The securities underlying the agreements remain in the asset accounts of the Company.

REVENUE RECOGNITION

Interest revenue from loans and investments is recognized on the accrual basis of accounting as the interest is earned according to the terms of the particular loan or investment. Income from service and other customer charges is recognized as earned. Card fee revenue within the MPS division is recognized as services are performed and service charges are earned in accordance with the terms of the various programs.

EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE (EPS)

Basic EPS is based on the net income divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Allocated ESOP shares are considered outstanding for earnings per common share calculations, as they are committed to be released; unallocated ESOP shares are not considered outstanding. Diluted EPS shows the dilutive effect of additional potential common shares issuable under stock option plans.

COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

Comprehensive income consists of net income and other comprehensive income. Other comprehensive income includes the net change in net unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, net of reclassification adjustments and tax effects, and is recognized as a separate component of stockholders’ equity.

STOCK COMPENSATION

 Compensation expense for share based awards is recorded over the vesting period at the fair value of the award at the time of grant. The exercise price of options or fair value of nonvested shares granted under the Company’s incentive plans is equal to the fair market value of the underlying stock at the grant date. The Company assumes no projected forfeitures on its stock based compensation, since actual historical forfeiture rates on its stock based incentive awards has been negligible.

RECLASSIFICATIONS

Certain reclassifications have been made to prior periods’ consolidated financial statements to present them on a basis comparable within the current period’s consolidated financial statements.

NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

Accounting Standards Update No.2010-20, "Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the Allowance for Credit Losses" (ASC Topic 310).

This ASU required significant new disclosures about the allowance for credit losses and the credit quality of financing receivables. The requirements are intended to enhance transparency regarding credit losses and the credit quality of loan and lease receivables. Under this statement, allowance for credit losses and fair value are to be disclosed by portfolio segment, while credit quality information, impaired financing receivables and nonaccrual status are to be presented by class of financing receivable. Disclosure of the nature and extent, the financial impact and segment information of restructured loans will also be required. The disclosures are to be presented at the level of disaggregation that management uses when assessing and monitoring the portfolio's risk and performance. The Company adopted this update effective in the first quarter of fiscal 2011 and the adoption did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-01, "Deferral of the Effective Date of Disclosures about Troubled Debt Restructurings in Update No. 2010-20" (ASC Topic 310).

This ASU modified the effective date of compliance with disclosure requirements related to trouble debt restructure reporting previously indicated in ASU 2010-20. The new effective date for disclosing the required troubled debt restructuring information is for interim and annual periods ending after June 15, 2011. The Company adopted this update effective in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 and the adoption did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.


Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-02, Receivables (Topic 310): A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring Is a Troubled Debt Restructuring

This ASU amends guidance for evaluating whether the restructuring of a receivable by a creditor is a troubled debt restructuring (TDR). The ASU responds to concerns that creditors are inconsistently applying existing guidance for identifying TDRs. ASU 2011-02 is effective for a public entity for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011. Retrospective application is required for restructurings occurring on or after the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption for purposes of identifying and disclosing TDRs. However, an entity should apply prospectively changes in the method used to calculate impairment on receivables. At the same time it adopts ASU 2011-02, a public entity will be required to disclose the activity-based information about TDRs that was previously deferred by ASU No. 2011-01, Deferral of the Effective Date of Disclosures about Troubled Debt Restructurings in Update No. 2010-20. The Company adopted ASU 2011-02 for the interim and annual period ending September 30, 2011. The adoption did not have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations, or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-03, Transfer and Servicing (Topic 860): Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements

This ASU applies to all entities that enter into agreements to transfer financial assets that both entitle and obligate the transferor to repurchase or redeem the financial assets before their maturity (repo arrangements). It focuses the transferor’s assessment of effective control on its contractual rights and obligations by removing the requirement to assess its ability to exercise those rights or honor those obligations. The ASU is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011. It is effective prospectively for transactions or modifications of existing transactions that occur on or after the effective date. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-03 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011 and the Company does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs

This ASU was issued concurrently with IFRS 13, Fair Value Measurements, to provide largely identical guidance about fair value measurement and disclosure requirements. The new standards do not extend the use of fair value but, rather, provide guidance about how fair value should be applied where it already is required or permitted under IFRS or U.S. GAAP. For U.S. GAAP, most of the changes are clarifications of existing guidance or wording changes to align with IFRS 13.

A public entity is required to apply the ASU prospectively for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is not permitted. In the period of adoption, a reporting entity will be required to disclose a change, if any, in valuation technique and related inputs that result from applying the ASU and to quantify the total effect, if practicable. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-04 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011 and the Company does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations, or cash flow.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Presentation of Comprehensive Income

This ASU increases the prominence of other comprehensive income in financial statements. Under this ASU, an entity will have the option to present the components of net income and comprehensive income in either one or two consecutive financial statements. The ASU eliminates the option in U.S. GAAP to present other comprehensive income in the statement of changes in equity.

An entity should apply the ASU retrospectively. For a public entity, the ASU is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company will adopt ASU 2011-05 for the interim period ending December 31, 2011.

Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-08 “Intangibles — Goodwill and Other” (ASC Topic 350).

The objective of this update is to simplify how entities test goodwill for impairment. This update adds a qualitative analysis to step one of the two-step process, which enables the Company to qualitatively determine if it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists, and if not, skip step two in determination of the amount of goodwill impairment. The guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011, but early adoption is permitted. The Company anticipates adopting this update in the second quarter of fiscal 2012 and does not expect the adoption to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flow.


NOTE 2. EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE (EPS)

A reconciliation of the income (loss) and common stock share amounts used in the computation of basic and diluted EPS for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009 is presented below.

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
Earnings (Loss)
                 
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,393     $ (1,463 )
                         
Basic EPS
                       
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    3,116,302       2,936,397       2,606,072  
Less weighted average nonvested shares
    (1,667 )     (3,329 )     (4,995 )
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    3,114,635       2,933,068       2,601,077  
                         
Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share
                       
Basic
  $ 1.49     $ 4.23     $ (0.56 )
                         
Diluted EPS
                       
Weighted average common shares outstanding for basic earnings per common share
    3,114,635       2,933,068       2,601,077  
Add dilutive effect of assumed exercises of stock options, net of tax benefits
    1,239       79,733       -  
Weighted average common and dilutive potential common shares outstanding
    3,115,874       3,012,801       2,601,077  
                         
Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share
                       
Diluted
  $ 1.49     $ 4.11     $ (0.56 )

Stock options totaling 365,488, 105,288, and 490,058 were not considered in computing diluted earnings per common share for the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively, because they were not dilutive.


NOTE 3. SECURITIES

Securities available for sale were as follows at September 30

         
GROSS
   
GROSS
       
   
AMORTIZED
   
UNREALIZED
   
UNREALIZED
   
FAIR
 
2011
 
COST
   
GAINS
   
(LOSSES)
   
VALUE
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Debt securities
                       
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ 30,582     $ -     $ (8,470 )   $ 22,112  
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    5,937       281       -       6,218  
Mortgage-backed securities
    572,467       18,591       (140 )     590,918  
Total debt securities
  $ 608,986     $ 18,872     $ (8,610 )   $ 619,248  
                                 
                                 
           
GROSS
   
GROSS
         
   
AMORTIZED
   
UNREALIZED
   
UNREALIZED
   
FAIR
 
2010
 
COST
   
GAINS
   
(LOSSES)
   
VALUE
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Debt securities
                               
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ 25,466     $ 7     $ (7,922 )   $ 17,551  
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    3,769       155       (8 )     3,916  
Mortgage-backed securities
    475,026       10,671       (312 )     485,385  
Total debt securities
  $ 504,261     $ 10,833     $ (8,242 )   $ 506,852  

Included in securities available for sale are trust preferred securities as follows:

At September 30, 2011
                             
               
Unrealized
   
S&P
   
Moody's
 
Issuer(1)
 
Book Value
   
Fair Value
   
Gain (Loss)
   
Credit Rating
   
Credit Rating
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
             
                                   
Key Corp. Capital I
  $ 4,982     $ 3,300     $ (1,682 )  
BB
   
Baa3
 
Huntington Capital Trust II SE
    4,972       3,350       (1,622 )  
BB-
   
Ba1
 
Bank Boston Capital Trust IV (2)
    4,965       2,999       (1,966 )  
BB+
   
Ba1
 
Bank America Capital III
    4,954       3,100       (1,854 )  
BB+
   
Ba1
 
PNC Capital Trust
    4,954       3,650       (1,304 )  
BBB
   
Baa2
 
Total
  $ 24,827     $ 16,399     $ (8,428 )                

(1) Trust preferred securities are single-issuance. There are no known deferrals, defaults or excess subordination.
(2) Bank Boston now known as Bank of America.

Management has a process to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary. This process involves evaluating the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, reviewing available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, and projecting cash flows. Other factors, but not necessarily all, considered are: that the risk of loss is minimized and easier to determine due to the single-issuer, rather than pooled, nature of the securities, the condition of the five banks listed, and whether there have been any payment deferrals or defaults to-date. Such factors are subject to change over time.


Management also determines if it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost basis which, in some cases, may extend to maturity. To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized

For all securities that are considered temporarily impaired, the Company does not intend to sell these securities (has not made a decision to sell) and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, which may occur at maturity. The Company believes that it will collect all principal and interest due on all investments that have amortized cost in excess of fair value that are considered only temporarily impaired.

Gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in continuous unrealized loss position at September 30, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:

   
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
   
OVER 12 MONTHS
   
TOTAL
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
2011
 
Value
   
(Losses)
   
Value
   
(Losses)
   
Value
   
(Losses)
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Debt securities
                                   
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ 5,713     $ (42 )   $ 16,399     $ (8,428 )   $ 22,112     $ (8,470 )
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    -       -       -       -       -       -  
Mortgage-backed securities
    23,886       (140 )     -       -       23,886       (140 )
Total debt securities
  $ 29,599     $ (182 )   $ 16,399     $ (8,428 )   $ 45,998     $ (8,610 )
                                                 
                                                 
   
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
   
OVER 12 MONTHS
   
TOTAL
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
2010
 
Value
   
(Losses)
   
Value
   
(Losses)
   
Value
   
(Losses)
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Debt securities
                                               
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ -     $ -     $ 17,551     $ (7,922 )   $ 17,551     $ (7,922 )
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    1,110       (8 )     -       -       1,110       (8 )
Mortgage-backed securities
    67,227       (312 )     -       -       67,227       (312 )
Total debt securities
  $ 68,337     $ (320 )   $ 17,551     $ (7,922 )   $ 85,888     $ (8,242 )

As of September 30, 2011, the investment portfolio included securities with current unrealized losses which have existed for longer than one year. All of these securities are considered to be acceptable credit risks. Because the declines in fair value were due to changes in market interest rates, not in estimated cash flows, no other-than-temporary impairment was recorded at September 30, 2011. As of September 30, 2010, the investment portfolio did include one security, the Cascade Capital Trust I 144A security, that had other-than-temporary-impairment. The difference between the present value of cash flows and the amortized cost basis was recorded as a credit loss impairment and recognized in earnings in the amount of $350,000.

The amortized cost and fair value of debt securities by contractual maturity are shown below. Certain securities have call features which allow the issuer to call the security prior to maturity. Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities in mortgage-backed securities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. Therefore, mortgage-backed securities are not included in the maturity categories in the following maturity summary.



   
AMORTIZED
   
FAIR
 
   
COST
   
VALUE
 
September 30, 2011
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
             
Due in one year or less
  $ 448     $ 458  
Due after one year through five years
    7,022       7,038  
Due after five years through ten years
    2,237       2,310  
Due after ten years
    26,812       18,524  
      36,519       28,330  
Mortgage-backed securities
    572,467       590,918  
Total debt securities
  $ 608,986     $ 619,248  

Activities related to the sale of securities available for sale are summarized below.

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Proceeds from sales
  $ 55,791     $ 97,610     $ 32,478  
Gross gains on sales
    1,793       2,224       762  
Gross losses on sales
    -       84       1  

NOTE 4. LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET

Year end loans receivable were as follows:

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
             
One to four family residential mortgage loans
  $ 33,753     $ 39,010  
One to four family residential mortgage loans held for sale
    375       1,444  
Commercial and multi-family real estate loans
    194,414       204,820  
Agricultural real estate loans
    20,320       25,895  
Consumer loans
    32,418       46,250  
Consumer loans held for sale
    1,980       1,863  
Commercial business loans
    14,955       19,709  
Agricultural business loans
    21,200       32,528  
Total Loans Receivable
    319,415       371,519  
                 
Less:
               
Allowance for loan losses
    (4,926 )     (5,234 )
Undisbursed portion of loans in process
    -       -  
Net deferred loan origination fees
    (79 )     (240 )
Total Loans Receivable, Net
  $ 314,410     $ 366,045  


Annual activity in the allowance for loan losses was as follows:

Year ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Continuing Operations:
                 
Beginning balance
  $ 5,234     $ 6,993     $ 5,732  
Provision for loan losses
    278       15,791       18,713  
Recoveries
    521       1,855       632  
Charge offs
    (1,107 )     (19,405 )     (18,084 )
Ending balance
  $ 4,926     $ 5,234     $ 6,993  

Allowance for Loan Losses and Recorded Investment in loans at September 30, 2011 is as follows:

   
1-4 Family Residential
   
Commercial and Multi Family Real Estate
   
Agricultural Real Estate
   
Consumer
   
Commercial Business
   
Agricultural Operating
   
Unallocated
   
Total
 
                                                 
Year Ended September 30, 2011
                                               
                                                 
Allowance for loan losses:
                                               
Beginning balance
  $ 50     $ 3,053     $ 111     $ 738     $ 131     $ 125     $ 1,026     $ 5,234  
Provision charged (credited) to expense
    344       807       (111 )     (367 )     (52 )     (58 )     (285 )     278  
Losses charged off
    (229 )     (61 )     -       (774 )     (43 )     -       -       (1,107 )
Recoveries
    -       102       -       419       -       -       -       521  
Ending balance
  $ 165     $ 3,901     $ -     $ 16     $ 36     $ 67     $ 741     $ 4,926  
                                                                 
                                                                 
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
  $ 1     $ 1,845     $ -     $ -     $ 3     $ -     $ -     $ 1,849  
Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
  $ 164     $ 2,056     $ -     $ 16     $ 33     $ 67     $ 741     $ 3,077  
Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
                                                                 
Loans:
                                                               
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
  $ 127     $ 13,025     $ -     $ -     $ 30     $ -     $ -     $ 13,182  
Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
  $ 33,922     $ 181,389     $ 20,320     $ 34,398     $ 14,925     $ 21,200     $ -     $ 306,154  
Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  

The Asset Classification at September 30, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:
 
September 30, 2011
                                   
   
1-4 Family Residential
   
Commercial and Multi Family Real Estate
   
Agricultural Real Estate
   
Consumer
   
Commercial Business
   
Agricultural Operating
 
                                     
Pass
  $ 33,830     $ 161,109     $ 20,320     $ 33,947     $ 13,737     $ 14,500  
Watch
    281       10,446       -       318       913       6,700  
Special Mention
    17       3,006       -       38       53       -  
Substandard
    -       19,827       -       60       252       -  
Doubtful
    -       26       -       35       -       -  
    $ 34,128     $ 194,414     $ 20,320     $ 34,398     $ 14,955     $ 21,200  

 
September 30, 2010
                                   
   
1-4 Family Residential
   
Commercial and Multi Family Real Estate
   
Agricultural Real Estate
   
Consumer
   
Commercial Business
   
Agricultural Operating
 
                                     
Pass
  $ 39,704     $ 182,812     $ 19,752     $ 47,349     $ 18,501     $ 22,874  
Watch
    750       4,869       3,094       119       710       8,261  
Special Mention
    -       7,109       -       197       108       1,393  
Substandard
    -       8,081       3,050       259       390       -  
Doubtful
    -       1,949       -       189       -       -  
    $ 40,454     $ 204,820     $ 25,896     $ 48,113     $ 19,709     $ 32,528  

Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent 90 days or more or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is taken out of current income. The loan will remain on a non-accrual status until the loan becomes current. Past due loans at September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010 are as follows:

September 30, 2011
 
30-59 Days Past Due
   
60-89 Days Past Due
   
Greater Than 90 Days
   
Total Past Due
   
Current
   
Total Loans Receivable
   
Loans > 90 Days and Accruing
 
                                           
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ 51     $ 30     $ 127     $ 208     $ 33,920     $ 34,128     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    2,460       -       9,075       11,535       182,879       194,414       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       -       20,320       20,320       -  
Consumer
    26       14       24       64       34,334       34,398       24  
Commercial Operating
    -       -       -       -       14,955       14,955       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       -       21,200       21,200       -  
Total
  $ 2,537     $ 44     $ 9,226     $ 11,807     $ 307,608     $ 319,415     $ 24  
                                                         
September 30, 2010
                                                       
                                                         
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ 192     $ 9     $ 443     $ 644     $ 39,570     $ 40,214     $ 404  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    3,900       746       4,394       9,040       195,780       204,820       257  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       2,196       2,196       23,700       25,896       -  
Consumer
    192       38       124       354       47,759       48,113       124  
Commercial Operating
    329       -       202       531       19,178       19,709       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       400       400       32,128       32,528       -  
Total
  $ 4,613     $ 793     $ 7,759     $ 13,165     $ 358,115     $ 371,280     $ 785  


Impaired loans at September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010 are as follows:

   
Recorded Balance
   
Unpaid Principal Balance
   
Specific Allowance
   
Average Investment in Impaired Loans
   
Interest Income Recognized
 
September 30, 2011
                             
                               
Loans without a specific valuation allowance
                             
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    -       -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       -       -  
Commercial Operating
    -       -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       -       -  
Total
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
Loans with a specific valuation allowance
                                       
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ 127     $ 172     $ 1     $ 117     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    13,025       18,427       1,845       9,306       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       1,176       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       36       -  
Commercial Operating
    30       45       3       109       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       80       -  
Total
  $ 13,182     $ 18,644     $ 1,849     $ 10,824     $ -  
                                         
                                         
   
Recorded Balance
   
Unpaid Principal Balance
   
Specific Allowance
   
Average Investment in Impaired Loans
   
Interest Income Recognized
 
September 30, 2010
                                       
                                         
Loans without a specific valuation allowance
                                       
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    -       -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       -       -  
Commercial Operating
    -       -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       -       -  
Total
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
Loans with a specific valuation allowance
                                       
Residential 1-4 Family
  $ 39     $ 39     $ 2     $ 165     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    4,137       9,684       266       8,336       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    2,650       2,650       21       530       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       26       -  
Commercial Operating
    241       241       121       501       -  
Agricultural Operating
    400       400       60       80       -  
Total
  $ 7,467     $ 13,014     $ 470     $ 9,638     $ -  
 
Cash interest collected on impaired loans was not material during the years ended September 30, 2011 and 2010.


For fical 2011 and 2010, the Company’s troubled debt restructurings (which involved forgiving a portion of interest or principal on any loans or making loans at a rate materially less than that of market rates) are included in the table. Troubled debt restructured loans at September 30, 2011 and September 30, 2010 are as follows:

   
September 30, 2011
   
September 30, 2010
 
   
Number of Loans
   
Pre-Modification Outstanding Recorded Balance
   
Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Balance
   
Number of Loans
   
Pre-Modification Outstanding Recorded Balance
   
Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Balance
 
                                     
Residential 1-4 Family
    3     $ 328     $ 328       1     $ 45     $ 45  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    8       8,390       8,424       2       377       377  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    1       19       19       -       -       -  
Commercial Operating
    3       67       111       -       -       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       -       -       -  
Total
    15     $ 8,804     $ 8,881       3     $ 422     $ 422  

The following table provides information on troubled debt restructured loans for which there was a payment default during the fiscal year ended September 30, 2011 and 2010, that had been modified during the 12-month period prior to the default:

   
With Payment Deafaults During the Following Periods
 
   
September 30, 2011
   
September 30, 2010
 
   
Number of Loans
   
Recorded Investment
   
Number of Loans
   
Recorded Investment
 
Residential 1-4 Family
    1     $ 42       -     $ -  
Commercial Real Estate and Multi Family
    -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Real Estate
    -       -       -       -  
Consumer
    -       -       -       -  
Commercial Operating
    -       -       -       -  
Agricultural Operating
    -       -       -       -  
Total
    1     $ 42       -     $ -  

Virtually all of the Company’s originated loans are to Iowa- and South Dakota-based individuals and organizations. The Company’s purchased loans totaled $23.2 million at September 30, 2011, which were secured by properties located, as a percentage of total loans, as follows: 2% in Iowa and Oregon, 1% each in Washington and Minnesota and the remaining 1% in seven other states.

The Company originates and purchases commercial real estate loans. These loans are considered by management to be of somewhat greater risk of uncollectibility due to the dependency on income production. The Company’s commercial real estate loans include $24.3 million of loans secured by hotel properties and $46.4 million of multi-family properties at September 30, 2011. The Company’s commercial real estate loans include $25.2 million of loans secured by hotel properties and $48.2 million of multi-family properties at September 30, 2010. The remainder of the commercial real estate portfolio is diversified by industry. The Company’s policy for requiring collateral and guarantees varies with the credit­worthiness of each borrower.

Non-Accruing loans were $13.2 million and $7.5 million at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively. There were $24,000 and $0.8 million accruing loans delinquent 90 days or more at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively.


NOTE 5. LOAN SERVICING

Loans serviced for others are not reported as assets. The unpaid principal balances of these loans at year end were as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
             
Mortgage loan portfolios serviced for FNMA
  $ 15,965     $ 15,837  
Other
    8,794       11,281  
    $ 24,759     $ 27,118  


NOTE 6. PREMISES, FURNITURE, AND EQUIPMENT, NET

Year end premises and equipment were as follows:

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
             
Land
  $ 2,429     $ 2,429  
Buildings
    13,369       13,357  
Furniture, fixtures, and equipment
    21,673       21,266  
      37,471       37,052  
Less accumulated depreciation
    (20,303 )     (17,675 )
    $ 17,168     $ 19,377  

Depreciation expense of premises, furniture, and equipment included in occupancy and equipment expense was approximately $3.8 million, $3.7 million, and $3.6 million for the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively.

NOTE 7. TIME CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSITS

Time certificates of deposits in denominations of $100,000 or more were approximately $38.0 million and $61.8 million at September 30, 2011, and 2010, respectively.

At September 30, 2011, the scheduled maturities of time certificates of deposits were as follows for the years ending:

September 30,
     
(Dollars in Thousands)
     
       
2012
  $ 62,357  
2013
    41,721  
2014
    5,607  
2015
    4,402  
2016
    2,475  
Total Certificates
  $ 116,562  

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, non-IRA deposit accounts are permanently insured up to $250,000 by the DIF under management of the FDIC. Previous to the legislation in 2010, the coverage of $250,000 was temporary until December 2013. IRA deposit accounts are permanently insured up to $250,000 by the DIF under management of the FDIC.


NOTE 8. ADVANCES FROM THE FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK AND OTHER BORROWINGS

At September 30, 2011, the Company’s advances from the FHLB had fixed rates ranging from 4.03% to 7.01% with a weighted average rate of 6.0%. The scheduled maturities of FHLB advances were as follows for the years ending:

September 30,
     
(Dollars in Thousands)
     
       
2012
  $ -  
2013
    2,500  
2014
    -  
2015
    1,500  
2016
    -  
Thereafter
    7,000  
Total FHLB Advances
  $ 11,000  

The Company had no overnight federal funds purchased from the FHLB as of September 30, 2011.

As of September 30, 2010, the Company’s advances from the FHLB totaled $22.0 million and carried a weighted average rate of 5.10%. The Company had no overnight federal funds purchased from the FHLB.

The Bank has executed blanket pledge agreements whereby the Bank assigns, transfers, and pledges to the FHLB and grants to the FHLB a security interest in all mortgage collateral and securities collateral. The Bank has the right to use, commingle, and dispose of the collateral it has assigned to the FHLB. Under the agreement, the Bank must maintain “eligible collateral” that has a “lending value” at least equal to the “required collateral amount,” all as defined by the agreement.

At year end 2011, and 2010, the Bank pledged securities with fair values of approximately $172.4 million and $198.3 million, respectively, against specific FHLB advances. In addition, qualifying mortgage loans of approximately $30.7 million, and $35.8 million were pledged as collateral at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

NOTE 9. SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase totaled approximately $8.1 million and $8.9 million at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

An analysis of securities sold under agreements to repurchase follows:

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
             
Highest month-end balance
  $ 11,787     $ 11,880  
Average balance
    6,018       7,479  
Weighted average interest rate for the year
    0.50 %     0.50 %
Weighted average interest rate at yearend
    0.50 %     0.50 %


The Company pledged securities with fair values of approximately $15.1 million at September 30, 2011, as collateral for securities sold under agreements to repurchase. There were $19.3 million securities pledged as collateral for securities sold under agreements to repurchase at September 30, 2010.

NOTE 10. SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES AND TRUST PREFERRED SECURITIES

Subordinated debentures are due to First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I, a 100%-owned nonconsolidated subsidiary of the Company. The debentures were issued in 2001 in conjunction with the Trust’s issuance of 10,000 shares of Trust Preferred Securities. The debentures bear the same interest rate and terms as the trust preferred securities. The debentures are included on the balance sheet as liabilities.

The Company issued all of the 10,000 authorized shares of trust preferred securities of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I holding solely subordinated debt securities. Distributions are paid semi-annually. Cumulative cash distributions are calculated at a variable rate of LIBOR (as defined) plus 3.75% (4.31% at September 30, 2011 and 4.21% at September 30, 2010), not to exceed 12.5%. The Company may, at one or more times, defer interest payments on the capital securities for up to 10 consecutive semi-annual periods, but not beyond July 25, 2031. At the end of any deferral period, all accumulated and unpaid distributions are required to be paid. The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has the option to shorten the maturity date to a date not earlier than July 25, 2007. The redemption price is $1,000 per capital security plus any accrued and unpaid distributions to the date of redemption plus, if redeemed prior to July 25, 2011, a redemption premium as defined in the Indenture agreement.

Holders of the capital securities have no voting rights, are unsecured and rank junior in priority of payment to all of the Company’s indebtedness and senior to the Company’s common stock.

Although the securities issued by the trusts are not included as a component of stockholders’ equity, the securities are treated as capital for regulatory purposes, subject to certain limitations.

NOTE 11. EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP AND PROFIT SHARING PLANS

The Company maintains an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) for eligible employees who have 1,000 hours of employment with the Bank, have worked one year at the Bank and who have attained age 21. ESOP expense of $737,000, $654,000 and $388,000 was recorded for the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Contributions of $772,000, $654,000 and $440,000 were made to the ESOP during the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Contributions to the ESOP and shares released from suspense are allocated among ESOP participants on the basis of compensation in the year of allocation. Benefits generally become 100% vested after seven years of credited service. Prior to the completion of seven years of credited service, a participant who terminates employment for reasons other than death or disability receives a reduced benefit based on the ESOP’s vesting schedule. Forfeitures are reallocated among remaining participating employees in the same proportion as contributions. Benefits are payable in the form of stock upon termination of employment. The Company’s contributions to the ESOP are not fixed, so benefits payable under the ESOP cannot be estimated.

For the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, 43,898 shares, 20,428 shares and 18,446 shares with a fair value of $17.58, $32.00 and $23.86 per share, respectively, were released. Also for the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, allocated shares and total ESOP shares reflect 20,938 shares, 15,966 shares, and 254 shares, respectively, withdrawn from the ESOP by participants who are no longer with the Company or by participants diversifying their holdings. At September 30, 2011, 11,567 shares were purchased for dividend reinvestment. At September 30, 2010 there were no shares purchased for dividend reinvestment. At September 30, 2009, 535 shares were purchased for dividend reinvestment.


Year-end ESOP shares are as follows:

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Allocated shares
    248,427       213,900       209,438  
Unearned shares
    -       -       -  
Total ESOP shares
    248,427       213,900       209,438  
                         
Fair value of unearned shares
  $ -     $ -     $ -  

The Company also has a profit sharing plan covering substantially all full-time employees. Contribution expense to the profit sharing plan, included in compensation and benefits, for the year ended September 30, 2011 and 2010 was $780,000 and $726,000, respectively. There was no contribution expense to the profit sharing plan for the year ended September 30, 2009.

NOTE 12. SHARE BASED COMPENSATION PLANS

The Company maintains the 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan which, among other things, provides for the awarding of stock options and nonvested (restricted) shares to certain officers and directors of the Company. Awards are granted by the Stock Option Committee of the Board of Directors based on the performance of the award recipients or other relevant factors.

The following table shows the effect to income, net of tax benefits, of share-based expense recorded in the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

Year Ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Total employee stock-based compensation expense recognized in income, net of tax effects of $45, $89 and $75, respectively
  $ 244     $ 450     $ 714  

As of September 30, 2011, stock-based compensation expense not yet recognized in income totaled $103,000 which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average remaining period of 0.53 years.

At grant date, the fair value of options awarded to recipients is estimated using a Black-Scholes valuation model. The exercise price of stock options equals the fair market value of the underlying stock at the date of grant. The following table shows the key valuation assumptions used for options granted during the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009, and other information. Options are issued for 10 year periods with 100% vesting generally occurring either at grant date or over a four year period.



Year Ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
                   
Risk-free interest rate
    0.95% - 0.96 %     1.27% - 2.36 %     1.50% - 2.82 %
                         
Expected annual standard deviation
                       
Range
    55.31% - 55.50 %     44.89% - 45.89 %     46.48% - 68.70 %
Weighted average
    55.32 %     45.06 %     51.04 %
Expected life (years)
    5       5       6  
                         
Expected dividend yield
                       
Range
    2.83% - 2.96 %     1.64% - 3.02 %     2.26% - 6.30 %
Weighted average
    2.95 %     1.69 %     3.05 %
Weighted average fair value of options granted during period
  $ 6.62     $ 10.83     $ 7.44  
Intrinsic value of options exercised during period
  $ 64     $ 426     $ 181  

The Company awarded nonvested shares during the fiscal years ended 2011, 2010 and 2009. Shares vest immediately up to a period of four years. The following table shows the weighted average fair value of nonvested (restricted) shares awarded and the total fair value of nonvested (restricted) shares which vested during the fiscal years ended 2011, 2010 and 2009. The fair value is determined based on the fair market value of the Company’s stock on the grant date.

Year Ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
Weighted average fair value of nonvested shares granted during period
  $ 17.90     $ 23.01     $ 16.00  
Total fair value of nonvested shares vested during period
  $ 147     $ 124     $ 124  

In addition to the Company’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, the Company also maintains the 1995 Stock Option and Incentive Plan. No new options were, or could have been, awarded under the 1995 plan during the year ended September 30, 2011; however, previously awarded but unexercised options were outstanding under this plan during the year.


The following tables show the activity of options and nonvested (restricted) shares granted, exercised, or forfeited under all of the Company’s option and incentive plans during the years ended September 30, 2011 and 2010.

               
Weighted
       
         
Weighted
   
Average
       
   
Number
   
Average
   
Remaining
   
Aggregate
 
   
of
   
Exercise
   
Contractual
   
Intrinsic
 
   
Shares
   
Price
   
Term (Yrs)
   
Value
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
                         
Options outstanding, September 30, 2010
    490,993     $ 23.39       6.49     $ 4,579  
Granted
    24,935       17.61                  
Exercised
    (13,776 )     13.65                  
Forfeited or expired
    (16,800 )     25.94                  
Options outstanding, September 30, 2011
    485,352     $ 23.28       5.90     $ 463  
                                 
Options exercisable end of year
    452,977     $ 23.31       5.91     $ 401  
                                 
                                 
                   
Weighted
         
           
Weighted
   
Average
         
   
Number
   
Average
   
Remaining
   
Aggregate
 
   
of
   
Exercise
   
Contractual
   
Intrinsic
 
   
Shares
   
Price
   
Term (Yrs)
   
Value
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
                                 
Options outstanding, September 30, 2009
    577,921     $ 23.74       7.12     $ 1,836  
Granted
    55,153       30.96                  
Exercised
    (41,544 )     16.29                  
Forfeited or expired
    (100,537 )     32.30                  
Options outstanding, September 30, 2010
    490,993     $ 23.39       6.49     $ 4,579  
                                 
Options exercisable end of year
    448,793     $ 23.38       6.45     $ 4,204  


   
Number of
   
Weighted Average
 
   
Shares
   
Fair Value At Grant
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
             
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2010
    1,667     $ 24.43  
Granted
    5,950       17.90  
Vested
    (7,617 )     19.33  
Forfeited or expired
    -       -  
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2011
    -     $ -  
                 
                 
   
Number of
   
Weighted Average
 
   
Shares
   
Fair Value At Grant
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
                 
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2009
    3,334     $ 24.43  
Granted
    3,600       23.01  
Vested
    (5,267 )     23.46  
Forfeited or expired
    -       -  
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2010
    1,667     $ 24.43  

NOTE 13. INCOME TAXES

The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated federal income tax return on a fiscal year basis.

The provision for income taxes consists of:

Years ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Federal:
                 
Current
  $ 4,101     $ 5,194     $ 299  
Deferred
    (783 )     1,175       (840 )
      3,318       6,369       (541 )
                         
State:
                       
Current
    460       928       128  
Deferred
    (155 )     123       (130 )
      305       1,051       (2 )
                         
Income tax expense (benefit)
  $ 3,623     $ 7,420     $ (543 )


Total income tax expense (benefit) differs from the statutory federal income tax rate as follows:

Years ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                   
Income tax expense (benefit) at 35% federal tax rate
  $ 2,892     $ 6,935     $ (682 )
Increase (decrease) resulting from:
                       
State income taxes net of federal benefit
    198       683       (1 )
Nontaxable buildup in cash surrender value
    (184 )     (184 )     (174 )
Incentive stock option expense
    52       46       200  
Tax exempt income
    (38 )     (25 )     (19 )
Nondeductible expenses
    728       78       101  
Other, net
    (25 )     (113 )     32  
Total income tax expense (benefit)
  $ 3,623     $ 7,420     $ (543 )

Year-end deferred tax assets and liabilities included in other assets and other liabilities consist of:

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Deferred tax assets:
           
 Bad debts
  $ 1,884     $ 2,002  
 Stock based compensation
    358       384  
 Operational reserve
    676       517  
 Other, net
    2,084       1,164  
Gross deferred tax assets
    5,002       4,067  
                 
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
 FHLB stock dividend
    (433 )     (433 )
 Premises and equipment
    (1,232 )     (1,455 )
 Patents
    (503 )     (412 )
 Prepaid expenses
    (658 )     (529 )
 Net unrealized gains on securities available for sale
    (3,925 )     (985 )
 Deferred loan fees
    (63 )     (63 )
Gross deferred tax liabilities
    (6,814 )     (3,877 )
                 
Net deferred tax assets (liabilities)
  $ (1,812 )   $ 190  
 
Federal income tax laws provided savings banks with additional bad debt deductions through September 30, 1987 totaling $6.7 million for the Bank. Accounting standards do not require a deferred tax liability to be recorded on this amount, which liability otherwise would total approximately $2.3 million at September 30, 2011, and 2010. If the Bank were to be liquidated or otherwise cease to be a bank, or if tax laws were to change, the $2.3 million would be recorded as expense.

The provisions of ASC 740, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes address the determination of how tax benefits claimed or expected to be claimed on a tax return should be recorded in the consolidated financial statements. Under ASC 740, the Company recognizes the tax benefits from an uncertain tax position only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained upon examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur, including the resolution of any related appeals or litigation. The tax benefits recognized in the consolidated financial statements from such a position are measured as the largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate resolution. Management believes that the realization of deferred tax assets is more likely than not based on the expectations as to future taxable income; therefore, there was no deferred tax valuation allowance at September 30, 2011 and 2010.


In addition, the Company is required to establish contingency reserves for material, known tax exposures. The Company’s tax reserves reflect management’s judgment as to the resolution of the issues involved if subject to judicial review. While the Company believes that its reserves are adequate to cover reasonably expected tax risks, there can be no assurance that, in all instances, an issue raised by a tax authority will be resolved at a financial cost that does not exceed its related reserve. With respect to these reserves, the Company’s income tax expense would include (i) any changes in tax reserves arising from material changes during the period in the facts and circumstances surrounding a tax issue, and (ii) any difference from the Company’s tax position as recorded in the financial statements and the final resolution of a tax issue during the period

Income tax returns for fiscal years 2009 thru 2011, with few exceptions, remain open to examination by federal and state taxing authorities. The Company determined that no liability for unrecognized tax benefits and associated accrued interest and penalties existed at September 30, 2011 and 2010.

NOTE 14. CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS AND RESTRICTIONS ON RETAINED EARNINGS

The Bank is the Company’s primary subsidiary. The Bank is subject to various regulatory capital requirements. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory or discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific quantitative capital guidelines using its assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The requirements are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total risk-based capital and Tier I capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and a leverage ratio consisting of Tier I capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined). As of September 30, 2011, the Bank met all capital adequacy requirements.

The Bank’s actual and required capital amounts and ratios are presented in the following table.
 
   
Actual
   
Minimum Requirement For
Capital Adequacy Purposes
   
Minimum Requirement To Be
Well Capitalized Under Prompt
Corrective Action Provisions
 
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
                                   
                                     
September 30, 2011
                                   
                                     
MetaBank
                                   
Tangible capital (to tangible assets)
  $ 80,824       6.38 %   $ 19,012       1.50 %     n/a       n/a  
Tier 1 (core) capital (to adjusted total assets)
    80,824       6.38       50,698       4.00     $ 63,372       5.00 %
Tier 1 (core) capital (to risk-weighted assets)
    80,824       18.97       17,046       4.00       25,568       6.00  
Total risk based capital (to risk weighted assets)
    85,750       20.12       34,091       8.00       42,614       10.00  
                                                 
                                                 
September 30, 2010
                                               
                                                 
MetaBank
                                               
Tangible capital (to tangible assets)
  $ 74,642       7.29 %   $ 15,368       1.50 %     n/a       n/a  
Tier 1 (core) capital (to adjusted total assets)
    74,642       7.29       40,981       4.00     $ 51,226       5.00 %
Tier 1 (core) capital (to risk-weighted assets)
    74,642       17.57       16,991       4.00       25,487       6.00  
Total risk based capital (to risk weighted assets)
    79,876       18.80       33,983       8.00       42,478       10.00  

Regulations limit the amount of dividends and other capital distributions that may be paid by a financial institution without prior approval of its primary regulator. The regulatory restriction is based on a three-tiered system with the greatest flexibility being afforded to well-capitalized (Tier 1) institutions. The Bank is currently a Tier 1 institution. Accordingly, the Bank can make, without prior regulatory approval, distributions during a calendar year up to 100% of their retained net income for the calendar year-to-date plus retained net income for the previous two calendar years (less any dividends previously paid) as long as they remain well-capitalized, as defined in prompt corrective action regulations, following the proposed distribution. Accordingly, at September 30, 2011, approximately $17.1 million of the Bank’s retained earnings were potentially available for distribution to the Company.


During 2010, the Office of Thrift Supervision ("OTS") issued Supervisory Directives to the Bank based on the OTS’ assessment of the Bank’s third-party relationship risk, enterprise risk management, and rapid growth (in the MPS division) and had also advised the Bank that the OTS had determined that the Bank engaged in unfair or deceptive acts or practices in violation of Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act and the OTS Advertising Regulation in connection with the Bank’s operation of the iAdvance line of credit program. On July 15, 2011, the Company and the Bank each stipulated and consented to a Cease and Desist Order (together, the "Orders" or the “Consent Orders”) issued by the OTS. Under the Orders, the OTS and the Bank agreed upon a Remuneration Plan to provide reimbursement to iAdvance Line of Credit borrowers affected by the Bank’s failure to implement a recurring use plan. The Remuneration Plan provides for an aggregate amount of $4.8 million to be paid iAdvance customers. The Bank also stipulated and consented to an Order of Assessment of a Civil Money Penalty (the "Assessment") providing for the Bank's payment of $400,000. The Orders and the Assessment became effective on July 15, 2011. Both sums were paid in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011. Under the terms of the Orders and the Assessment, the OTS acknowledged that the Company and the Bank neither admitted nor denied the OTS findings in the Orders and the Assessment or that grounds existed to initiate a proceeding.

The Orders require the Company and the Bank to submit to the OTS (or its successor) various management and compliance plans and programs to address the matters initially identified in the Supervisory Directives as well as plans for enhancing Company and Bank capital and require non-objection by OTS (or its successor) for Company cash dividends, distributions, share repurchases, payments of interest or principal on debt and incurrence of debt. Under the terms of the Order, the Bank agrees that it will cease and desist from (1) violations of certain laws and regulations and (2) unsafe or unsound practices that resulted in it operating without adequate: (a) internal controls, management information systems and internal audit reviews of its third party sponsorship arrangements; and (b) certain information technology policies and procedures. The limitations related to MPS following the issuance of the Supervisory Directives remain in place. Such limitations include receiving the prior written approval of the Regional Director of the OTS (or its successor) before the Bank may (1) enter into any new third party relationship agreement concerning any credit product, deposit product (including prepaid cards), or automatic teller machine or materially amend any such existing agreement (except for amendments to achieve compliance with applicable laws, regulations, or regulatory guidance); (2) originate, directly or through any third party, tax refund anticipation loans; (3) offer a tax refund transfer processing service directly or through any third party; or (4) offer or originate iAdvance lines of credit to new customers or permit draws on existing iAdvance lines of credit, either directly or through any third party.

Compliance with the Orders will be subject to the review and supervision of the OCC with respect the Bank and the Federal Reserve Board with respect to the Company. There can be no assurance that the Company or the Bank can fully comply with the requirements of the Orders or receive non-objection to the Company's payment of dividends and interest.

The Orders further require the Company and the Bank to submit to the OTS (or its successor) various management and compliance plans and programs to address the matters initially identified in the Supervisory Directives as well as plans for enhancing Company and Bank capital. Although there can be no assurance that such actions will continue in the future, by separate letter agreement, the OTS took no objection to the Company’s request to prepay its scheduled July 2011 trust preferred security payment; similarly, the Federal Reserve has approved the Company’s declaration of a dividend payable on January 1, 2012 to stockholders of record on December 12, 2011. Both the Company and the Bank remain well-capitalized under federal banking guidelines after the reimbursement and the Assessment.

Since the issuance of the Supervisory Directives and the Consent Orders, the Company and the Bank have been cooperating with the OTS and the OCC to correct those aspects of its operations that were addressed in the Orders, and management of the Company and the Bank believe they have already made substantial progress. The Company and the Bank have completed many of the items in the Orders and expect to complete all of the required actions in the Orders by their respective deadline dates.


On July 21, 2011, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the OTS was integrated into the OCC and the functions of the OTS related to thrift holding companies were transferred to the Federal Reserve Board. The OCC is now responsible for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of the Bank. The Dodd-Frank Act maintains the existence of the federal savings association charter and the HOLA, the primary statute governing the federal savings banks. The Federal Reserve Board is now responsible for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of the Company.

NOTE 15. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

In the normal course of business, the Bank makes various commitments to extend credit which are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

At September 30, 2011 and 2010, unfunded loan commitments approximated $48.0 million and $37.8 million respectively, excluding undisbursed portions of loans in process. Unfunded loan commitments at September 30, 2011 and 2010 were principally for variable rate loans. Commitments, which are disbursed subject to certain limitations, extend over various periods of time. Generally, unused commitments are canceled upon expiration of the commitment term as outlined in each individual contract.

The exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by other parties to financial instruments for commitments to extend credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The same credit policies and collateral requirements are used in making commitments and conditional obligations as are used for on-balance-sheet instruments.

Since certain commitments to make loans and to fund lines of credit and loans in process expire without being used, the amount does not necessarily represent future cash commitments. In addition, commitments used to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.

Securities with fair values of approximately $18.0 million and $9.9 million at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged as collateral for public funds on deposit. Securities with fair values of approximately $13.9 million and $16.6 million at September 30, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged as collateral for individual, trust and estate deposits.

Under employment agreements with certain executive officers, certain events leading to separation from the Company could result in cash payments totaling approximately $4.6 million as of September 30, 2011. Currently, however, pursuant to the Consent Orders, and subject to certain exceptions, no payments that are contingent on the termination of employment of such officers may be made.

Legal Proceedings

Lawsuits against MetaBank involving the sale of purported MetaBank certificates of deposit continue to be addressed. In all, nine cases have been filed to date, and of those nine, three have been dismissed, and five have been settled for payments that the Company deemed reasonable under the circumstances, including the costs of litigation. Most recently, the class action, Guardian Angel Credit Union v. MetaBank et al., Case No. 08-cv-261-PB (USDC, District of NH), was settled.

There is now one remaining lawsuit relating to this matter: Airline Pilots Assoc Federal Credit Union v. MetaBank, filed in the Iowa District court for Polk County, Case No. CL-118792. The underlying matter was first disclosed in the Company's quarterly report for the period ended December 31, 2007, which stated that an employee of the Bank had sold fraudulent CDs for her own benefit. The unauthorized and illegal actions of the employee have since prompted a number of demands and lawsuits seeking recovery on the fraudulent CDs to be filed against the Bank, which have been disclosed in subsequent filings. The employee was prosecuted, convicted and, on June 2, 2010, sentenced to more than seven years in federal prison and ordered to pay more than $4 million in restitution. Notwithstanding the nature of her crimes, which were unknown by the Bank and its management, plaintiff in the remaining case seeks to impose liability on the Bank under a number of legal theories with respect to the $99,000 fraudulent CD that was issued by the former employee. The Bank and its insurer, which has assumed defense of the action and which is advancing defense costs subject to a reservation of rights, continue to vigorously contest liability in the remaining actions.


Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust Company v MetaBank, Case No. LACV007196. In a separate matter, on November 3, 2009, Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust Company ("CRBT") filed a Petition against MetaBank in the Iowa District Court in and for Linn County claiming an unspecified amount of money damages against MetaBank arising from CRBT's participation in loans originated by MetaBank to companies owned or controlled by Dan Nelson. The complaint states that the Nelson companies eventually filed for bankruptcy and the loans, including CRBT's portion, were not fully repaid. Under a variety of theories, CRBT claims that MetaBank had material negative information about Dan Nelson, his companies and the loans that it did not share with CRBT prior to CRBT taking a participation interest. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, this matter was settled for a payment deemed reasonable under the circumstances, including costs of litigation.

In re Meta Financial Group, Inc., Securities Litigation; Case No. C10-4108MWB. Two former stockholders filed separate purported class action lawsuits against the Company and certain of its officers alleging violations of certain federal securities laws. The cases were filed on October 22, 2010 and November 5, 2010 in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Iowa purportedly on behalf of those who purchased the Company's stock between May 14, 2009 and October 15, 2010. On January 12, 2011, Judge Mark W. Bennett appointed The Eden Partnership lead plaintiff and on March 14, 2011 Eden Partnership filed its amended complaint. The amended complaint alleges that the named officers violated Sections 10(b) and 20(a) of the Securities Exchange Act and SEC Rule 10b-5 in connection with certain allegedly false and misleading public statements made between May 14, 2009 and October 15, 2010 by the Company and its officers. Defendants moved to dismiss the amended complaint in its entirety but on July 18, 2011, the court denied the motion and ordered that discovery proceed. The parties conducted a mediation on December 5, 2011 and reached a tentative settlement of the matter. After the terms of the settlement are reduced to a definitive settlement agreement, the settlement must then be reviewed by the court, submitted to the class members for their consideration and comment, and finally approved by the court before the matter can be dismissed with prejudice. As of the filing of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, provided that the amount of the tentative settlement is approved by the court and the amount of the settlement is paid by the Company's insurance as expected by the Company, the Company does not expect to incur losses in addition to the amounts that it has previously expensed which would be material to its consolidated financial statements.
 
On December 9, 2011, a stockholder derivative complaint captioned Brown v. Haahr, et al., CL 123931, was filed in the Iowa District Court for Polk County against certain officers and directors of the Company. The suit alleges that named parties breached their fiduciary duties to the Company by, among other things, making statements between May, 2009 and October, 2010, which plaintiff claims were false and misleading and by allegedly failing to implement adequate internal controls and means of supervision at the Company. The individual defendants intend to vigorously defend the suit. An estimate of a range of possible loss cannot be made as of the filing of this Annual Report on Form 10-K because of the early stage of the litigation.

In addition to the previously disclosed ATM lawsuits filed in 2011, there were two lawsuits filed in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, and four additional lawsuits since, concerning ATMs sponsored by MetaBank, each involving claims that a notification required to be placed upon an automated teller machine was absent on a specific date, in violation of Regulation E of the Electronic Fund Transfer Act: Wallace Stilz, III. v. Meta Financial Group, Inc., Case No. 1:11-cv-04531, filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois, Eastern Division; and Spencer Webb, Individually and on Behalf of all Others Similarly Situated v. MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02178-H-NLS, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; Tamara Vance, on behalf of herself and a class v. MetaBank, N.A. and Does 1-5, Case No. 1:11-cv-06972, filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois, Eastern Division; Ian Collins, Individually and on Behalf of All Others Similarly Situated v. Mission Gorge Liquor, MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02345-L-POR, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; Spencer Webb, Individually and on Behalf of all Others Similarly Situated v. MetaBank, Meta Payment Systems, Swipe USA, LLC, and Does 1-10, Inclusive, Case No. 3:11-cv-02240-MMA-BLM, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of California; and Matthew Johns v. MAF Systems ATM, MetaBank, ATM Express Inc., Does 1-10 and XYZ Corporation, Case No. 2011-25436, filed in the Court of Common Pleas, Montgomery County, Pennsylvania. The Company denies liability in these matters, and will contest these lawsuits with the ATM operators, which are each obligated to indemnify the Company for losses, costs and expenses in these matters. An estimate of a range of possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because the extent of the Company’s indemnification by the ATM operators is unknown.


Patrick Finn and Light House Management Group, Inc. as Receiver for First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnson v. MetaBank et al, Case 5:11-cv-04041. On May 4, 2011, Patrick Finn and Light House Management Group, Inc. as Receivers for First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnson (“Receivers”) filed a complaint against MetaBank in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Iowa requesting judgment avoiding approximately $1.5 million of transfers that allegedly resulted in a profit to MetaBank arising from MetaBank’s participation in loans originated by First United Funding, LLC. Similar complaints have been filed by the Receivers against other lenders who purchased participation interests in the same or similar loans originated by First United Funding, LLC. The complaint states that First United Funding, LLC and Corey N. Johnston were involved in a criminal enterprise to defraud creditors. Under a variety of theories, Receivers claim that loan repayments to MetaBank constitute fraudulent transfers and MetaBank was unjustly enriched to the detriment of these creditors. MetaBank intends to vigorously defend the case. An estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.5 million as of the filing date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Bank utilizes various third parties for, among other things, its processing needs, both with respect to standard Bank operations and with respect to its MPS division. MPS was notified in April 2008 by one of the processors that the processor's computer system had been breached, which led to the unauthorized load and spending of funds from Bank-issued cards. The Bank believes the amount in question to be approximately $2.0 million. The processor and program manager both have agreements with the Bank to indemnify it for any losses as a result of such unauthorized activity, and the matter is reflected as such in its financial statements. In addition, the Bank has given notice to its own insurer. The Bank has been notified by the processor that its insurer has denied the claim filed. The Bank made demand for payment and filed a demand for arbitration to recover the unauthorized loading and spending amounts and certain damages. The Bank has settled its claim with the program manager, and has received an arbitration award against the processor. That arbitration has been entered as a judgment in the State of South Dakota, which judgment has been transferred to the State of Florida for garnishment proceedings against the processor and its insurer. The Company’s estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.5 million as of the filing date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Certain corporate clients of an unrelated company named Springbok Services, Inc. (“Springbok”) requested through counsel a mediation as a means of reaching a settlement in lieu of commencing litigation against MetaBank. The results of that mediation have not led to a settlement. These claimants purchased MetaBank prepaid reward cards from Springbok, prior to Springbok’s bankruptcy. As a result of Springbok’s bankruptcy and cessation of business, some of the rewards cards which had been purchased were never activated or funded. Counsel for these companies have indicated that they are prepared to assert claims totaling approximately $1.5 million against MetaBank based on principal/agency or failure to supervise theories. The Company denies liability with respect to these claims. The Company’s estimate of a range of possible loss is approximately $0 to $0.3 million.

For further discussion, see Note 14 herein.


NOTE 16. LEASE COMMITMENTS

The Company has leased property under various noncancelable operating lease agreements which expire at various times through 2036, and require annual rentals ranging from $3,400 to $988,000 plus the payment of the property taxes, normal maintenance, and insurance on certain property.

The following table shows the total minimum rental commitment at September 30, 2011, under the leases.

September 30,
     
(Dollars in Thousands)
     
       
2012
  $ 1,548  
2013
    1,353  
2014
    1,186  
2015
    1,126  
2016
    1,150  
Thereafter
    3,093  
Total Leases Commitments
  $ 9,456  

NOTE 17. SEGMENT REPORTING

An operating segment is generally defined as a component of a business for which discrete financial information is available and whose results are reviewed by the chief operating decision-maker. Operating segments are aggregated into reportable segments if certain criteria are met. The Company has determined that it has two reportable segments. The first reportable segment, Retail Banking, consists of its banking subsidiary, the Bank. The Bank operates as a traditional community bank providing deposit, loan and other related products to individuals and small businesses, primarily in the communities where their offices are located. The second reportable segment, MPS, is a division of the Bank. MPS provides a number of products and services to financial institutions and other businesses. These products and services include issuance of prepaid debit cards, sponsorship of ATMs into the debit networks, credit programs, ACH origination services, gift card programs, rebate programs, travel programs, and tax related programs. Other programs are in the process of development. The remaining grouping under the caption “All Others” consists of the operations of the Company and Meta Trust and inter-segment eliminations.

Transactions between affiliates, the resulting revenues of which are shown in the intersegment revenue category, are conducted at market prices, meaning prices that would be paid if the companies were not affiliates.

   
Retail Banking
   
Meta Payment Systems®
   
All Others
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Year Ended September 30, 2011
                       
Interest income
  $ 27,249     $ 11,682     $ 128     $ 39,059  
Interest expense
    4,127       153       467       4,747  
Net interest income (loss)
    23,122       11,529       (339 )     34,312  
Provision for loan losses
    650       (372 )     -       278  
Non-interest income
    3,595       53,486       410       57,491  
Non-interest expense
    23,686       59,179       397       83,262  
Income (loss) before tax
    2,381       6,208       (326 )     8,263  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    1,451       2,304       (132 )     3,623  
Income (loss)
  $ 930     $ 3,904     $ (194 )   $ 4,640  
                                 
Inter-segment revenue (expense)
  $ 9,890     $ (9,890 )   $ -     $ -  
Total assets
    308,184       965,388       1,909       1,275,481  
Total deposits
    216,909       925,246       (535 )     1,141,620  


   
Retail 
Banking
   
Meta Payment 
Systems®
   
All Others
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Year Ended September 30, 2010
                       
Interest income
  $ 25,771     $ 13,267     $ 45     $ 39,083  
Interest expense
    5,155       362       476       5,993  
Net interest income (loss)
    20,616       12,905       (431 )     33,090  
Provision for loan losses
    4,375       11,416       -       15,791  
Non-interest income
    4,174       93,202       68       97,444  
Non-interest expense
    19,452       74,462       1,016       94,930  
Income (loss) before tax
    963       20,229       (1,379 )     19,813  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    367       7,606       (553 )     7,420  
Income (loss)
  $ 596     $ 12,623     $ (826 )   $ 12,393  
                                 
Inter-segment revenue (expense)
  $ 9,560     $ (9,560 )   $ -     $ -  
Total assets
    341,488       685,690       2,588       1,029,766  
Total deposits
    242,969       655,243       (758 )     897,454  
 
   
Retail 
Banking
   
Meta Payment 
Systems®
   
All Others
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Year Ended September 30, 2009
                               
Interest income
  $ 35,083     $ 9,415     $ (7,772 )   $ 36,726  
Interest expense
    15,332       844       (7,269 )     8,907  
Net interest income (loss)
    19,751       8,571       (503 )     27,819  
Provision for loan losses
    10,427       8,286       -       18,713  
Non-interest income
    2,480       77,396       93       79,969  
Non-interest expense
    18,800       71,016       1,265       91,081  
Income (loss) before tax
    (6,996 )     6,665       (1,675 )     (2,006 )
Income tax expense (benefit)
    (2,545 )     2,567       (565 )     (543 )
Income (loss)
  $ (4,451 )   $ 4,098     $ (1,110 )   $ (1,463 )
                                 
Inter-segment revenue (expense)
  $ 8,466     $ (8,466 )   $ -     $ -  
Total assets
    389,053       441,794       3,930       834,777  
Total deposits
    231,961       422,090       (304 )     653,747  


The following tables present gross profit data for MPS for the years ended September 30, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Fiscal Year Ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Interest income
  $ 11,682     $ 13,267     $ 9,415  
Interest expense
    153       362       844  
Net interest income
    11,529       12,905       8,571  
                         
Provision for loan losses
    (372 )     11,416       8,286  
Non-interest income
    53,486       93,202       77,396  
Card processing expense
    23,261       38,242       34,350  
Gross Profit
    42,126       56,449       43,331  
                         
Other non-interest expense
    35,918       36,220       36,666  
                         
Income from operations before tax
    6,208       20,229       6,665  
Income tax expense
    2,304       7,606       2,567  
Income from operations
  $ 3,904     $ 12,623     $ 4,098  


NOTE 18. PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Presented below are condensed financial statements for the parent company, Meta Financial.

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
       
             
September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
ASSETS
           
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 1,624     $ 883  
Securities available for sale
    -       658  
Investment in subsidiaries
    88,476       79,146  
Other assets
    881       1,697  
Total assets
  $ 90,981     $ 82,384  
                 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
               
                 
LIABILITIES
               
Subordinated debentures
  $ 10,310     $ 10,310  
Other liabilities
    94       30  
Total liabilities
  $ 10,404     $ 10,340  
                 
STOCKOLDERS' EQUITY
               
Common stock
    34       34  
Additional paid-in capital
    32,471       32,381  
Retained earnings
    45,494       42,475  
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    6,336       1,599  
Treasury stock, at cost
    (3,758 )     (4,445 )
Total stockholders' equity
  $ 80,577     $ 72,044  
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity
  $ 90,981     $ 82,384  

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                 
                   
Years ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Gain on sale of securities available for sale
  $ 385     $ -     $ -  
Other income
    153       55       115  
Total income
    538       55       115  
                         
Interest expense
    467       487       617  
Other expense
    397       804       1,095  
Total expense
    864       1,291       1,712  
                         
Income (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed net income (loss) of subsidiaries
    (326 )     (1,236 )     (1,597 )
                         
Income tax benefit
    (132 )     (498 )     (536 )
                         
Income (loss) before equity in undistributed net income (loss) of subsidiaries
    (194 )     (738 )     (1,061 )
                         
Equity in undistributed net income (loss) of subsidiaries
    4,834       13,130       (402 )
                         
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,392     $ (1,463 )



CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
     
                   
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
                 
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,640     $ 12,393     $ (1,463 )
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activites
                 
Equity in undistributed net income (loss) of subsidiaries
    (4,834 )     (13,130 )     402  
Gain on sale of securities available for sale
    (385 )     -       -  
Change in other assets
    816       (423 )     (1,047 )
Change in other liabilities
    64       (777 )     452  
Other, net
    -       -       5  
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
    301       (1,937 )     (1,651 )
                         
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITES
                       
Investment in subsidiary
    246       -       -  
Capital contributions subsidiaries
    -       (6,157 )     -  
Proceeds from the sale of securities available for sale
    1,035       -       -  
Other, net
    3       262       15  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activites
    1,284       (5,895 )     15  
                         
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
                       
Net change in loan payable to subsidiaries
    -       (250 )     (250 )
Cash dividends paid
    (1,621 )     (1,544 )     (1,353 )
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
    575       1,330       15  
Other, net
    202       9,083       1,224  
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (844 )     8,619       (364 )
                         
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
  $ 741     $ 787     $ (2,000 )
                         
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
                       
Beginning of year
  $ 883     $ 96     $ 2,096  
End of year
  $ 1,624     $ 883     $ 96  

The extent to which the Company may pay cash dividends to stockholders will depend on the cash currently available at the Company, as well as the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to the Company. For further discussion, see Note 14 herein.
 

NOTE 19. SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)

   
QUARTER ENDED
 
   
December 31
   
March 31
   
June 30
   
September 30
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                         
Fiscal Year 2011
                       
Interest income
  $ 9,620     $ 9,580     $ 9,980     $ 9,879  
Interest expense
    1,342       1,163       1,153       1,089  
Net interest income
    8,278       8,417       8,827       8,790  
Provision for loan losses
    (28 )     214       (161 )     253  
Income (loss)
    721       2,747       (1,020 )     2,192  
Earnings (loss) per common and common equivalent share
                               
Basic
  $ 0.23     $ 0.88     $ (0.33 )   $ 0.81  
Diluted
    0.23       0.88       (0.33 )     0.81  
Dividend declared per share
    0.13       0.13       0.13       0.13  
                                 
Fiscal Year 2010
                               
Interest income
  $ 9,064     $ 10,383     $ 10,114     $ 9,522  
Interest expense
    1,745       1,382       1,456       1,410  
Net interest income
    7,319       9,001       8,658       8,112  
Provision for loan losses
    4,691       9,478       609       1,013  
Income
    1,192       5,174       3,538       2,489  
Earnings per common and common equivalent share
                               
Basic
  $ 0.45     $ 1.76     $ 1.15     $ 0.87  
Diluted
  $ 0.45     $ 1.74     $ 1.11     $ 0.81  
Dividend declared per share
    0.13       0.13       0.13       0.13  
                                 
Fiscal Year 2009
                               
Interest income
  $ 8,726     $ 10,534     $ 8,465     $ 9,001  
Interest expense
    2,565       2,289       2,121       1,932  
Net interest income
    6,161       8,245       6,344       7,069  
Provision for loan losses
    2,129       10,270       6,277       37  
Income (loss)
    673       1,175       (2,582 )     (729 )
Earnings (loss) per common and common equivalent share
                               
Basic
  $ 0.26     $ 0.45     $ (0.99 )   $ (0.28 )
Diluted
  $ 0.26     $ 0.45     $ (0.99 )   $ (0.28 )
Dividend declared per share
    0.13       0.13       0.13       0.13  

NOTE 20. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring the fair value of assets and liabilities using a hierarchy system and expands disclosures about fair value measurement. It clarifies that fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants in the market in which the reporting entity transacts.

The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

Level 1 Inputs – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical instruments traded in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at measurement date.

Level 2 Inputs – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in active markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which significant assumptions are observable in the market.

Level 3 Inputs – Valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market and are used only to the extent that observable inputs are not available. These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques include use of option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.


Securities Available for Sale. Securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Fair value measurement is based upon quoted prices, if available. If quoted prices are not available, fair values are measured using an independent pricing service. Level 1 securities include those traded on an active exchange, such as the New York Stock Exchange, as well as U.S. Treasury and other U.S. government and agency securities that are traded by dealers or brokers in active over-the-counter markets. The Company had no Level 1 or Level 3 securities at September 30, 2011 and 2010. Level 2 securities include agency mortgage-backed securities and private collateralized mortgage obligations, municipal bonds and corporate debt securities.

The fair values of securities available for sale are determined by obtaining quoted prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges (Level 1 inputs), or matrix pricing, which is a mathematical technique widely used in the industry to value debt securities without relying exclusively on quoted prices for the specific securities, but rather by relying on the securities’ relationship to other benchmark quoted securities (Level 2 inputs). The Company outsources this valuation primarily to a third party provider which utilizes several sources for valuing fixed-income securities. Sources utilized by the third party provider include pricing models that vary based by asset class and include available trade, bid, and other market information. This methodology includes broker quotes, proprietary models, descriptive terms and conditions databases, as well as extensive quality control programs.

The following table summarizes the assets of the Company for which fair values are determined on a recurring basis at September 30, 2011 and 2010.

   
Fair Value at September 30, 2011
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Total
   
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
Level 3
 
Debt securities
                       
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ 22,112     $ -     $ 22,112     $ -  
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    6,218       -       6,218       -  
Mortgage-backed securities
    590,918       -       590,918       -  
Securities available for sale
  $ 619,248     $ -     $ 619,248     $ -  
                                 
                                 
   
Fair Value at September 30, 2010
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Total
   
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
Level 3
 
Debt securities
                               
Trust preferred and corporate securities
  $ 17,551     $ -     $ 17,551     $ -  
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
    3,916       -       3,916       -  
Mortgage-backed securities
    485,385       -       485,385       -  
Securities available for sale
  $ 506,852     $ -     $ 506,852     $ -  

Foreclosed Real Estate and Repossessed Assets. Real estate properties and repossessed assets are initially recorded at the fair value less selling costs at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis. The carrying amount at September 30, 2011 represents the lower of the new cost basis or the fair value less selling costs of foreclosed assets that were measured at fair value subsequent to their initial classification as foreclosed assets.

Loans. The Company does not record loans at fair value on a recurring basis. However, if a loan is considered impaired, an allowance for loan losses is established. Once a loan is identified as individually impaired, management measures impairment in accordance with ASC 310, Accounting for Creditors for Impairment of a Loan.


The following table summarizes the assets of the Company for which fair values are determined on a non-recurring basis as of September 30, 2011.

   
Fair Value at September 30, 2011
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Total
   
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
Level 3
 
                         
Foreclosed Assets, net
  $ 2,671     $ -     $ 2,671     $ -  
Loans
    20,200       -       -       20,200  
Total
  $ 22,871     $ -     $ 2,671     $ 20,200  
                                 
                                 
   
Fair Value at September 30, 2010
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Total
   
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
Level 3
 
                                 
Foreclosed Assets, net
  $ 1,295     $ -     $ 1,295     $ -  
Loans
    13,919       -       -       13,919  
Total
  $ 15,214     $ -     $ 1,295     $ 13,919  

The following table discloses the Company’s estimated fair value amounts of its financial instruments. It is management’s belief that the fair values presented below are reasonable based on the valuation techniques and data available to the Company as of September 30, 2011 and 2010, as more fully described below. The operations of the Company are man­aged from a going concern basis and not a liquidation basis. As a result, the ultimate value realized for the finan­cial instruments presented could be substantially different when actually recognized over time through the normal course of operations. Additionally, a substantial portion of the Company’s inherent value is the Banks’ capitalization and franchise value. Neither of these components have been given consideration in the presentation of fair values below.

The following presents the carrying amount and estimated fair value of the financial instruments held by the Company at September 30, 2011 and 2010. The information presented is subject to change over time based on a variety of factors.

September 30,
 
2011
   
2010
 
   
Carrying
   
Estimated
   
Carrying
   
Estimated
 
   
Amount
   
Fair Value
   
Amount
   
Fair Value
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                         
Financial assets
                       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 276,893     $ 276,893     $ 87,503     $ 87,503  
Securities available for sale
    619,248       619,248       506,852       506,852  
Loans receivable, net
    314,410       316,152       366,045       369,301  
FHLB stock
    4,737       4,737       5,283       5,283  
Accrued interest receivable
    4,133       4,133       4,759       4,759  
                                 
Financial liabilities
                               
Noninterest bearing demand deposits
    945,956       945,956       675,163       675,163  
Interest bearing demand deposits, savings, and money markets
    79,102       79,102       76,219       76,219  
Certificates of deposit
    116,562       118,288       146,072       148,490  
Total deposits
    1,141,620       1,143,346       897,454       899,872  
                                 
Advances from FHLB
    11,000       14,128       22,000       25,563  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    8,055       8,055       8,904       8,904  
Subordinated debentures
    10,310       10,325       10,310       10,294  
Accrued interest payable
    223       223       392       392  
                                 
Off-balance-sheet instruments, loan commitments
    -       -       -       -  


The following sets forth the methods and assumptions used in determining the fair value estimates for the Company’s financial instruments at September 30, 2011 and 2010.

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

The carrying amount of cash and short-term investments is assumed to approximate the fair value.

SECURITIES AVAILABLE FOR SALE

Securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Fair values for investment securities are based on obtaining quoted prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges, or matrix pricing, which is a mathematical technique widely used in the industry to value debt securities without relying exclusively on quoted prices for the specific securities, but rather by relying on the securities’ relationship to other benchmark quoted securities.

LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET

The fair value of loans is estimated using a historical or replacement cost basis concept (i.e. an entrance price concept). The fair value of loans was estimated by discounting the future cash flows using the current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings and for similar remaining maturities. When using the discounting method to determine fair value, loans were gathered by homogeneous groups with similar terms and conditions and discounted at a target rate at which similar loans would be made to borrowers at September 30, 2011 and 2010. In addition, when computing the estimated fair value for all loans, allowances for loan losses have been subtracted from the calculated fair value for consideration of credit quality.

FHLB STOCK

The fair value of such stock is assumed to approximate book value since the Company is generally able to redeem this stock at par value.

ACCRUED INTEREST RECEIVABLE

The carrying amount of accrued interest receivable is assumed to approximate the fair value.

DEPOSITS

The carrying values of non-interest bearing checking deposits, interest bearing checking deposits, savings, and money markets is assumed to approximate fair value, since such deposits are immediately withdrawable without penalty. The fair value of time certificates of deposit was estimated by discounting expected future cash flows by the current rates offered on certificates of deposit with similar remaining maturities.

In accordance with ASC 825, no value has been assigned to the Company’s long-term relationships with its deposit customers (core value of deposits intangible) since such intangible is not a financial instrument as defined under ASC 825.

ADVANCES FROM FHLB

The fair value of such advances was estimated by discounting the expected future cash flows using current interest rates as of September 30, 2011 and 2010 for advances with similar terms and remaining maturities.

SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE AND SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES

The fair value of these instruments was estimated by discounting the expected future cash flows using derived interest rates approximating market as of September 30, 2011 and 2010 over the contractual maturity of such borrowings.

ACCRUED INTEREST PAYABLE

The carrying amount of accrued interest payable is assumed to approximate the fair value.

LOAN COMMITMENTS

The commitments to originate and purchase loans have terms that are consistent with current market terms. Accordingly, the Company estimates that the fair values of these commitments are not significant.


LIMITATIONS

It must be noted that fair value estimates are made at a specific point in time, based on relevant market information about the financial instrument. Additionally, fair value estimates are based on existing on- and off-balance sheet financial instruments without attempting to estimate the value of anticipated future business, customer relationships and the value of assets and liabilities that are not considered financial instruments. These estimates do not reflect any premium or discount that could result from offering the Company’s entire holdings of a particular financial instrument for sale at one time. Furthermore, since no market exists for certain of the Company’s financial instruments, fair value estimates may be based on judgments regarding future expected loss experience, current economic conditions, risk characteristics of various financial instruments and other factors. These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and therefore cannot be determined with a high level of precision. Changes in assumptions as well as tax considerations could significantly affect the estimates. Accordingly, based on the limitations described above, the aggregate fair value estimates are not intended to represent the underlying value of the Company, on either a going concern or a liquidation basis.

NOTE 21. GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

The changes in the carrying amount of the Company’s goodwill and intangible assets for the years ended September 30, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:


   
Traditional
   
Meta Payment
   
Meta Payment
       
   
Banking
   
Systems®
   
Systems®
       
   
Goodwill
   
Patents
   
Other
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                         
Balance as of September 30, 2010
  $ 1,508     $ 1,078     $ 77     $ 2,663  
                                 
Acquisitions during the period
    -       478       -       478  
                                 
Amortization during the period
    -       -       (77 )     (77 )
                                 
Write-offs during the period
    (1,508 )     (241 )     -       (1,749 )
                                 
Balance as of September 30, 2011
  $ -     $ 1,315     $ -     $ 1,315  
                                 
                                 
                                 
   
Traditional
   
Meta Payment
   
Meta Payment
         
   
Banking
   
Systems®
   
Systems®
         
   
Goodwill
   
Patents
 
Other
   
Total
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                 
Balance as of September 30, 2009
  $ 1,508     $ 707     $ -     $ 2,215  
                                 
Acquisitions during the period
    -       425       231       656  
                                 
Amortization during the period
    -       -       (154 )     (154 )
                                 
Dispositions during the period
    -       (54 )     -       (54 )
                                 
Balance as of September 30, 2010
  $ 1,508     $ 1,078     $ 77     $ 2,663  


The Company had no amortizable intangible assets recorded at September 30, 2011 and had one amortizable intangible asset recorded at September 30, 2010.

The Company tests goodwill and intangible assets for impairment at least annually or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment. There was an impairment to goodwill during the year ended September 30, 2011 of $1.5 million due primarily to the decline in the stock price of the Company at that period. There was no impairment to goodwill and intangible assets during the year ended September 30, 2010.

Changes In and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

Controls and Procedures

(a)           Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The Company’s management, with the participation of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s “disclosure controls and procedures”, as such term is defined in Rules 13a–15(e) and 15d–15(e) under the Exchange Act as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective in timely alerting them to the material information relating to the Company required to be included in the Company’s periodic SEC filings. In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended September 30, 2011 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

(b)           Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP. Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and directors; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Internal control over financial reporting, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations. Because of such inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2011, based on the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in “Internal Control-Integrated Framework.” After conducting the assessment, management determined that, as of September 30, 2011, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective, based on those criteria.

The effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2011, has been audited by KPMG LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm who also has audited the Company's consolidated financial statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. KPMG LLP's report on the Company's internal control over financial reporting appears on the following page and is voluntarily included by the Company under SEC Rules.


KPMG LLP
2500 Ruan Center
666 Grand Avenue
Des Moines, IA 50309

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Meta Financial Group, Inc.:

We have audited Meta Financial Group, Inc.’s (the Company’s) internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Controls over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, Meta Financial Group, Inc maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statements of financial condition of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended September 30, 2011, and our report dated December 19, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

 
/s/ KPMG LLP

Des Moines, Iowa
December 19, 2011


Other Information

None.

PART III
 
Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Directors

Information concerning directors of the Company required by this item will be included under the captions “Election of Directors,” "Communicating with Our Directors" and "Stockholder Proposals For The Year 2013 Annual Meeting" in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on January 30, 2012, a copy of which will be filed not later than 120 days after September 30, 2011 (the “2011 Proxy Statement”), and is incorporated herein by reference.

Executive Officers

Information concerning the executive officers of the Company required by this item is set forth under the caption “Executive Officer of the Company Who is Not a Director” contained in Part I, Item 1 “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference.

Compliance with Section 16(a)

Information required by this item regarding compliance with Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act will be included under the caption “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Audit Committee Financial Expert
 
Information regarding the audit committee of the Company’s Board of Directors, including information regarding Jeanne Partlow, the audit committee financial expert serving on the audit committee for fiscal 2011 will be included under the captions “Meetings and Committees” and “Election of Directors” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Code of Ethics
Information regarding the Company’s Code of Ethics will be included under the caption “Corporate Governance” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11.
Executive Compensation

Information concerning executive and director compensation will be included under the captions “Compensation Processes and Procedures,” “Compensation of Directors” and “Executive Compensation” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters


 
(a)
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management

The information required by this item will be included under the caption “Stock Ownership” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
(b)
Changes in Control
 
Management of the Company knows of no arrangements, including any pledge by any persons of securities of the Company, the operation of which may, at a subsequent date; result in a change in control of the Registrant.

 
(c)
Equity Compensation Plan Information

The Company maintains the 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan for purposes of issuing stock based compensation to employees and directors.  An amendment to this plan, authorizing an additional 750,000 shares to be issued under this plan, was approved by the Board of Directors on November 30, 2007, and by the stockholders at the annual meeting held February 12, 2008.  The Company also has unexercised options outstanding under a previous stock option plan. The following table provides information about the Company’s common stock that may be issued under the Company’s omnibus incentive plans.

 
 
Plan Category
 
Number of securities to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options, warrants and rights
   
Weighted-average exercise price of outstanding options, warrants and rights
   
Number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plan excluding securities reflected in (a))
 
                   
Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders
    485,352     $ 23.28       622,761  
                         
Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders
    0     $ 0.00       0  
 
Item 13.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

The information required by this item will be included under the captions “Election of Directors,” “Meetings and Committees” and “Related Person Transactions” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14.
Principal Accounting Fees and Services

The information required by this item will be included under the caption “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Company’s 2011 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 

PART IV

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

The following is a list of documents filed as part of this report:

 
(a)
Financial Statements:

The following financial statements are included under Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K:

 
1.
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 
2.
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition as of September 30, 2011 and 2010.

 
3.
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 
4.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 
5.
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 
6.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended September 30, 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 
7.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 
(b)
Exhibits:

See Index of Exhibits.

 
(c)
Financial Statement Schedules:

All financial statement schedules have been omitted as the information is not required under the related instructions or is inapplicable.


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.


   
META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
       
Date:   December 19, 2011
 
By:
/s/ J. Tyler Haahr
     
J. Tyler Haahr, Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

By:
 /s/ J. Tyler Haahr
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
J. Tyler Haahr, Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer
     
 
 (Principal Executive Officer)
     
         
By:
 /s/ E. Thurman Gaskill
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
E. Thurman Gaskill, Vice Chairman
     
         
By:
/s/ Bradley C. Hanson
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
Bradley C. Hanson, Director
     
         
By:
/s/ Frederick V. Moore
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
Frederick V. Moore, Director
     
         
By:
/s/ Troy Moore III
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
Troy Moore III, Director
     
         
By:
/s/ Rodney G. Muilenburg
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
Rodney G. Muilenburg, Director
     
         
By:
/s/ Jeanne Partlow
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
Jeanne Partlow, Director
     
         
By:
/s/ David W. Leedom
 
Date:
December 20, 2011
 
David W. Leedom, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
     
 
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
     



INDEX TO EXHIBITS


Exhibit Number
 
Description
     
3(i)
 
Registrant’s Certificate of Incorporation as currently in effect, filed on February 19, 2010 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (Commission File No. 333-164997), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
3(ii)
 
Registrant’s Bylaws, as amended and restated, filed as Exhibit 3(ii) to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
4.1
 
Registrant’s Specimen Stock Certificate, filed on February 19, 2010 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (Commission File No. 333-164997), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.1
 
Registrant’s 1995 Stock Option and Incentive Plan, filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-KSB for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.2
 
Employment agreement between MetaBank and J. Tyler Haahr, originally filed as an exhibit to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference. First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.3
 
Registrant’s Supplemental Employees’ Investment Plan, originally filed as an exhibit to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-KSB for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1994 (Commission File No. 0-22140). First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.4
 
Employment agreement between MetaBank and James S. Haahr, originally filed on June 17, 1993 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (Commission File No. 33-64654). First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 33-64654), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.5
 
Registrant’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, filed as Exhibit 10.9 to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2003 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.6
 
Employment agreement between MetaBank and Bradley C. Hanson, originally filed as an exhibit to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2005 (Commission File No. 0-22140). First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.7
 
Employment agreement between MetaBank and Troy Moore III, originally filed as an exhibit to Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2005 (Commission File No. 0-22140). First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.8
 
The First Amendment to Registrant’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, adopted by the Registrant on August 28, 2006, and filed on December 19, 2006 as Exhibit A to Registrant’s Schedule 14A (DEF 14A) Proxy Statement (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated by reference.
     
*10.9
 
The Second Amendment to Registrant’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, adopted by the Registrant on November 30, 2007, and filed on January 3, 2008 as Exhibit A to Registrant’s Schedule 14A (DEF 14A) Proxy Statement (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated by reference.
     
*10.10
 
Employment agreement between MetaBank and David W. Leedom, dated October 27, 2008 filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008 (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.11
 
Amended and Restated Contract for Deferred Compensation between MetaBank and James S. Haahr, dated September 27, 2005 and the first amendment thereto filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008, is incorporated herein by reference.
     
*10.12
 
Consulting Services Agreement between the Company and James S. Haahr, dated October 10, 2011 and effective as of October 1, 2011, filed on October 12, 2011 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Report on Form 8-K (Commission File No. 0-22140), is incorporated herein by reference.
     
11
 
Statement re: computation of per share earnings (See Note 2 of “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K).
     
 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant is filed herewith.
     
 
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm is filed herewith.
     
 
Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
     
 
Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
     
 
Certification of the CEO pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
     
 
Certification of the CFO pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.

101.INS
Instance Document Filed Herewith.
   
101.SCH
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document Filed Herewith.
   
101.CAL
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
   
101.DEF
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
   
101.LAB
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
   
101.PRE
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
 
______________
 
*Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Agreement
 
2